B721 / B731 / MPS5501b
Maintenance Manual
012615A
Copyright Information
Copyright 2013by Oki Data. All Rights Reserved
Disclaimer
Every effort has been made to ensure that the information in this document is complete, accurate, and up-todate. The manufacturer assumes no responsibility for the results of errors beyond its control. The
manufacturer also cannot guarantee that changes in software and equipment made by other manufacturers and
referred to in this guide will not affect the applicability of the information in it. Mention of software products
manufactured by other companies does not necessarily constitute endorsement by the manufacturer.
While all reasonable efforts have been made to make this document as accurate and helpful as possible, we
make no warranty of any kind, expressed or implied, as to the accuracy or completeness of the information
contained herein.
The most up-to-date drivers and manuals are available from the web site:
http://www.okiprintingsolutions.com
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
PREFACE
PREFACE
This manual explains maintenance methods for B721/B731/ES7131/MPS5501b.
The manual has been prepared for use by the maintenance personnel. For operating
methods of B721/B731/ES7131/MPS5501b, refer to the corresponding users manual.
Note! The contents of this manual are subject to changes without prior notice.
Despite that exhaustive efforts were made in preparing the manual to
make it accurate, it still may contain errors. Oki Data will not hold itself
liable for any damage that results or is claimed to have resulted from repair,
adjustment, or modification of the printer conducted by the user using this
manual.
The parts employed in the printer are so delicate that they may be damaged
if not treated properly. Oki Data Corporation highly recommends that the
maintenance of the printer is undertaken by ODCs registered maintenance
personnel.
Work after eliminating static electricity.
45487001TH Rev.1
iii /
Contents
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Contents
1. Configuration........................................................................1-1
1.1 System configuration .......................................................................................1-2
1.2 Printer configuration .........................................................................................1-3
1.3 Composition of optional items ..........................................................................1-4
1.4 Specifications....................................................................................................1-5
1.5 Interface specifications ....................................................................................1-8
1.5.1 USB interface specifications ................................................................1-8
2.4 List of components and accessories.................................................................2-5
2.5 Assembly procedure.........................................................................................2-6
2.5.1 Assembly of the printer main unit.........................................................2-6
2.5.2 Connection of the AC cord.................................................................2-12
2.5.3 Installation and recognition confirmation of options...........................2-14
2.6 Printing of the configuration report..................................................................2-28
2.7 Connection methods.......................................................................................2-29
2.8 Checking of paper used by the user...............................................................2-39
1.5.1.1
USB interface overview.......................................................1-8
1.5.1.2
USB interface connectors and cables ................................1-8
3. Component replacement.....................................................3-1
1.5.1.3
USB interface signals..........................................................1-8
3.1 Precautions on component replacement..........................................................3-2
1.5.2 Network interface specifications ..........................................................1-9
1.5.2.1
Network interface overview.................................................1-9
1.5.2.2
Network interface connector and cable ..............................1-9
1.5.2.3
Network interface signals ...................................................1-9
1.5.3 USB host interface specifications ......................................................1-10
1.5.3.1
USB host interface overview ...........................................1-10
1.5.3.2
USB host interface connector............................................1-10
1.5.3.3
USB host interface signals................................................1-10
1.5.4 Wireless LAN interface specifications (Wireless Model only).............1-10
1.5.4.1
Wireless LAN interface overview.......................................1-10
1.5.5 Parallel interface specifications (Parallel installed Model only)...........1-11
1.5.5.1
Parallel interface overview ...............................................1-11
1.5.5.2
Parallel interface connector and cable...............................1-11
1.5.5.3
Parallel interface signals....................................................1-11
1.5.5.4
Parallel interface levels .....................................................1-11
2. Installation.............................................................................2-1
2.1 Cautions, and dos and donts...........................................................................2-2
2.2 Unpacking procedure........................................................................................2-3
2.3 Printer installation instructions..........................................................................2-4
45487001TH Rev.1
3.2 Method of component replacement..................................................................3-4
3.2.1 Transfer roller........................................................................................3-4
3.2.2 Fuser unit.............................................................................................3-5
3.2.3 Cover-Rear-Blind .................................................................................3-5
3.2.4 Cover side-L ........................................................................................3-6
3.2.5 Cover side-R.........................................................................................3-6
3.2.6 PU/CU-Board.......................................................................................3-7
3.2.6.1 PU/CU-Board......................................................................3-7
3.2.6.2
How to remove Battery(PU/CU-Board)................................3-8
3.2.7 Power supply unit.................................................................................3-9
3.2.8 DC motor (hop) / DC motor (ID) ..........................................................3-9
3.2.9 Motor FAN (PSU) ...............................................................................3-10
3.2.10 Motor FAN (ID) / Micro switch ............................................................3-10
3.2.11 HV-Board / Motor-FAN .......................................................................3-11
3.2.12 LED Assy ...........................................................................................3-11
3.2.13 Plate-Assy-Duct .................................................................................3-12
3.2.14 Frame-Assy-OP-Panel .......................................................................3-13
3.2.15 LCD panel..........................................................................................3-13
3.2.16 Cover-Assy-Front ...............................................................................3-14
3.2.17 Feeder-Assy-Regist / Clutch ..............................................................3-15
iv /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Contents
3.2.18 TR-Assy-Front....................................................................................3-16
4.4.1 Notes on PU/CU board replacement..................................................4-36
3.2.19 TR-Assy-Rear.....................................................................................3-17
4.5 Manual density adjustment setting..................................................................4-38
3.2.20 Cover-Assy-Stacker ...........................................................................3-17
4.6 Boot Menu List................................................................................................4-39
3.2.21 Eject-Assy .........................................................................................3-18
5. Cleaning................................................................................5-1
3.2.22 DC motor (fuser) ................................................................................3-20
3.2.23 Paper feed rollers ..............................................................................3-21
3.2.24 Paper feed rollers (MP tray) ...............................................................3-23
3.2.25 W-LAN Board (for Wireless model only) ............................................3-25
5.1 Cleaning............................................................................................................5-2
5.2 LED lens array cleaning....................................................................................5-3
5.3 Paper feed roller cleaning.................................................................................5-6
3.2.26 Centro Board (for Centro model only) ...............................................3-26
6. Troubleshooting procedure..................................................6-1
3.3 Portions Lubricated.........................................................................................3-27
6.1 Important notes to start the repair work............................................................6-2
4. Maintenace menus...............................................................4-1
6.2 Matters to be checked before taking corrective actions against abnormalities.6-2
4.1 System maintenance menu (For maintenance personnel)...............................4-2
4.2 Maintenance Utility............................................................................................4-3
4.3 User maintenance menu functions...................................................................4-5
4.3.1 Maintenance menu (for end-users)......................................................4-5
4.3.2 Self-diagnostic mode..........................................................................4-20
4.3.2.1
Operator panel..................................................................4-20
4.3.2.2
Normal self-diagnostic mode (Level 1)..............................4-22
4.3.2.2.1 Entering self-diagnostic mode (level 1).............................4-22
4.3.2.2.2 Exiting self-diagnostic mode..............................................4-22
4.3.2.3
Switch scan test................................................................4-23
4.3.2.4
Motor and clutch test.........................................................4-25
4.3.2.5
Test print............................................................................4-27
4.3.2.6
Consumable counter display.............................................4-30
4.3.2.7
Print counter display..........................................................4-31
4.3.2.8
Factory-Shipping mode switching......................................4-31
4.3.2.9
Self-diagnostic function setting..........................................4-32
4.3.2.10 LED head serial number display........................................4-33
4.3.2.11 Contrast adjustment..........................................................4-33
4.3.2.12 BUZZER TEST..................................................................4-34
4.3.3 Printing on stand-alone basis.............................................................4-34
4.3.4 Functions of buttons when/after power-on.........................................4-35
4.4 Setup after part replacement..........................................................................4-36
6.3 Precautions when taking corrective actions against abnormalities...................6-2
6.4 Preparation for troubleshooting.........................................................................6-2
6.5 Troubleshooting methods..................................................................................6-3
6.5.1 LCD message list.................................................................................6-3
6.5.2 Preparation for troubleshooting..........................................................6-30
6.5.2 (1) LCD display error...............................................................6-31
6.5.2.(2) Abnormal operations of the printer
after the power is turned on...............................................6-32
6.5.2.(3) Paper feed jam (Error 391: 1st Tray)..................................6-48
6.5.2.(4) Feed jam (Error 380).........................................................6-49
6.5.2.(5) Paper feed jam (Error 390: MP Tray).................................6-51
6.5.2.(6) Paper running jam (Error 381)...........................................6-52
6.5.2.(7) Paper unloading jam (Error 382).......................................6-55
6.5.2.(8) Two-sided printing jam
(Errors 370, 371, 372, 373 and 383) ................................6-56
6.5.2.(9) Paper size error (Errors 400 and 401)...............................6-57
6.5.2.(10) Fuser unit error (Errors 167 to 177)...................................6-58
6.5.2.(11) Motor fan error (Errors 122, 127, 128, 918).......................6-59
6.5.2.(12) Print speed is slow. (Performance is low.).........................6-60
6.5.2.(13) Option unit cannot be recognized......................................6-60
6.5.2.(14) LED head cannot be recognized.(Errors 134)...................6-61
6.5.2.(15) Toner cartridge cannot be recognized.(Errors 543)...........6-62
6.5.2.(16) Fuse cut error (Errors 155) ...............................................6-63
6.5.2.(17) Humidity sensor error (Error 123)......................................6-64
45487001TH Rev.1
v/
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Contents
6.5.2.(18) Wiring diagram..................................................................6-65
6.5.3 Troubleshooting the abnormal images...............................................6-66
6.5.3.(1) Color has faded-out and blurred entirely.
(Refer to Figure 6-2 A.)......................................................6-67
6.5.3.(2) Stain on white print. (Refer to Figure 6-2 B.).....................6-68
6.5.3.(3) White print (Refer to Figure 6-2 C.)...................................6-69
6.5.3.(4) Black banding/black streaking in vertical direction............6-70
6.5.3.(5) Periodic abnormalities (Refer to Figure 6-2 E.).................6-70
6.5.3.(6) Solid black printing.............................................................6-71
6.5.4 Image Quality Issues..........................................................................6-72
6.5.5 Network troubleshooting.....................................................................6-73
6.5.5.1 Connection error occurs with the Web browser.....................6-73
6.5.5.2 Print operation is not possible...............................................6-77
6.5.5.3 Cannot create Certificate........................................................6-78
6.5.5.4 Installation of Certificate is not possible.................................6-78
6.5.5.5 Other questions ....................................................................6-80
6.5.5.6 Restrictions when using Internet Explore 7...........................6-82
6.5.6 Wireless Troubleshooting....................................................................6-83
6.6 Paper cassette switches and paper size correlation table..............................6-84
7. Connection diagrams...........................................................7-1
7.1 Resistance value check....................................................................................7-2
7.2 Parts location....................................................................................................7-5
7.3 F/W version number........................................................................................7-12
7.3.1 Maintenance board indication stamp..................................................7-12
45487001TH Rev.1
vi /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1. Configuration
1.1 System configuration .................................................................1-2
1.2 Printer configuration ..................................................................1-3
1.3 Composition of optional items ...................................................1-4
1.4 Specifications.............................................................................1-5
1.5 Interface specifications ..............................................................1-8
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.1 System configuration
Figure 1-1 represents the system configuration of the printer.
Dup
motor
Dup
clutch
Dup
solenoid
HOP
motor
TAG PCB(ID)
HOP
clutch
REG1
clutch
REG2
clutch
TRAY1
HOP
clutch
ID
motor
ID2 FAN
Toner
sensor
PCB
TAG PCB(TC)
STKFL
sensor
HEAD
WLAN
module
2nd Tray PCB
REG
clutch
HOP
motor
LAN
Front sensor
PCB
TRAY1 PE sensor
USB
TRAY1 HOP sensor
HOST USB
(Front)
IN1 sensor
IN2 sensor
ID thermistor
IN
sensor
Paper
size
sensor
REG
clutch
PE
sensor
HOP
clutch
HOP
sensor
HOP
motor
Centro PCB
PU/CU PCB
TRAY1 paper size switch
DUPF sensor
MPT PE sensor
DUP IN sensor
WR2 sensor
EXIT sensor
3rd Tray PCB
Rear switch
MPT
clutch
FU sensor
IN
sensor
Fuser
FAN
ID1
FAN
PCQ PCB
High-voltage
power supply
PCB
Control panel
PCB
Enviromental sensor
PCB
Cover
switch1
(IL)
Option
HDD
Power
FAN
PE
sensor
HOP
sensor
HOP
motor
Fuser
motor
Fuser unit
HOP
clutch
Power SW
PCB
Paper
size
sensor
Low-voltage
power supply
PCB
4th Tray PCB
REG
clutch
Inlet
IN
sensor
Paper
size
sensor
PE
sensor
HOP
sensor
Figure 1-1
45487001TH Rev.1
1-2 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.2 Printer configuration
The internal part of the printer is composed of the following sections:
Electrophotographic processing section
Paper paths
Controller (a combination PU/CU board)
Operator panel
Power supplies (high-voltage power supply/low-voltage power supply)
Figure 1-2 represents the configuration of the printer.
Figure 1-2
45487001TH Rev.1
1-3 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.3 Composition of optional items
The following optional items are available for B721/B731/ES7131/MPS5501b:
(4) 160 GB hard disk
(1) Additional tray unit (tray 2/3/4)
(5) LCF
(2) Printer Stand
(3) Additional RAM (512 MB)
45487001TH Rev.1
1-4 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.4 Specifications
Classifi-cation
Dimension
Item
Specification(s)
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
Width
435 mm
Depth
498 mm
Height
410 mm
Weight
Approx. 27kg
Classifi-cation
Power
consump-tion
Line length
Line length
Engine speed
(A4/LT)
Simplex
47 / 49 ppm
Warm-up time
From power on: 25 seconds
(at room temperature 25C, rated voltage)
Resolution
LED head
52 / 55 ppm
Unavailable
1200dpi
Maximum input
resolution
1,200 1,200 dpi
Output resolution
1,200 1,200 dpi
600 600 dpi
Toner save mode
Toner saving by decreasing brightness
CPU
Core
RAM
Resident
ROM
Program + font
45487001TH Rev.1
Power input
Specification(s)
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
110 - 127 VAC (Range 99 - 140 VAC)
220 - 240 VAC (Range 198 - 264 VAC)
Off mode
Less than 0.4 W (120 V model)
Less than 0.45 W (230 V model)
Sleep mode
1.5 W (no Wireless LAN Model)
3.9 W (Wireless LAN Model)
Power save mode
20 W (120 V model full option)
22 W (230 V model full option)
A4 / Letter
Idle
Typical operation
From power save mode: 19 seconds
(at room temperature 25C, rated voltage)
Low-noise mode
Item
Peak
Operating
environ-ment
(temperature)
Operating
Operating
environ-ment
(humidity)
Operating
Non-operating
Non-operating
95 W
800 W
850 W
1,400 W
10C to 32C
0C to 43C, power off
20% to 80%,
maximum wet-bulb temperature: 25C
10% to 90%,
maximum wet-bulb temperature: 26.8C,
power-off
PPC464FP
256 MB (768 MB max.)
64 MB
1-5 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Classifi-cation
Service life
Item
Printer life
Print duty
Paper
handling
Specification(s)
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
1,200,000 pages or 5 years
Max. 280,000 pages/
month
Starter
Toner
life
5%
Starter
36,000pages (ES7131/MPS5501b)
Consumable
36,000pages (ES7131/MPS5501b)
Image
drum
life
Simplex
100,000 pages (when printed continuously)
72,000 pages (3 pages/job)
40,000 pages (1 page/job)
Duplex
80,000 pages (when printed continuously)
58,000 pages (3 pages/job)
32,000 pages (1 page/job)
10,000pages (B721/B731)
200,000 pages
Fuser unit life
200,000 pages
Tray capacity (1st
tray)
530 sheets of 80 g/m2
Tray capacity (MP
tray)
100 sheets of 80 g/m2
Tray capacity
(2nd/3rd/4th tray
(option))
530 sheets of 80 g/m2
45487001TH Rev.1
Minimum
paper size
100 sheets (80g/m2) to the face-up stacker,
500 sheets (80g/m2) to the face down stacker
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
Legal 13/13.5/14, letter, executive, statement, A4, A5,
B5, custom size, 16K (197 x 273 mm, 195 x 270 mm,
184 x 260 mm), envelope (Com-9, Com-10)
MP tray
Legal 13/13.5/14, letter, executive, statement, A4, A5,
A6, B5, B6, C5, C6, DL, Monarch, index card (3 x 5
inch), custom size, 16K (197 x 273 mm, 195 x 270
mm, 184 x 260 mm), photo size (4 x 6 inch/5 x 7 inch),
banner up to 52 inch
2nd/3rd/4th tray
(option)
Legal 13/13.5/14, letter, executive, statement, A4, A5,
B5, custom size, 16K (197 x 273 mm, 195 x 270 mm,
184 x 260 mm), envelope (Com-10)
Duplex
Legal 13/13.5/14, letter, executive, statement, A4, B5,
16K (197 x 273 mm, 195 x 270 mm, 184 x 260 mm),
custom size (148 - 216 mm (W) x 210 - 356 mm (L))
Custom size
1st tray, 2nd/3rd/4th tray (option):
148 - 216 mm (W), 210 - 356 mm (L)
(5.8 - 8.5 inches (W), 8.3 - 14.0 inches (L))
MP Tray:
76.2 - 216 mm (W), 127 - 1321 mm (L)
(3.0 - 8.5 inches (W), 5 -52 inches (L))
1st/2nd/3rd/4th
tray
MPT
Duplex
Media weight
Specification(s)
1st tary
18,000pages/25,000pages (B721/B731)
36,000pages(B731)
Transfer roller life
Paper ejection
Paper size
Item
Max. 280,000 pages/
month
Toner
life
ISO/
IEC
19752
Consumable
Classifi-cation
148 210 mm /A5
3 x 5 inch /index card
148 210 mm
1st/2nd/3rd/4th
tray
64 g/m2 to 220 g/m2
MPT
64 g/m2 to 253 g/m2
Duplex
64 g/m2 to 220 g/m2
1-6 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Classifi-cation
Operator
panel
Item
LCD
LED (color)
Button
Status switch/ Paper empty
sensor
Paper low
Specification(s)
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
Graphic panel with 128 64 dots,
no display of paper size
20 buttons
Ten-key pad
Power Save button (green)
Operational buttons (7 buttons:
ON LINE/CANCEL/ENTER/ / / /HELP)
Yes
Cover open
Yes
Fuser
temperature
Yes
Paper size detect
(1st/2nd/3rd/4th
tray)
Yes
(A5/B5/Executive/Leter/A4/Legal/COM10)
Paper size detect
(MP tray)
No
No
Continuouse
roll paper sag
detection
No
Option (removable)
Specification(s)
B721
B731/ES7131/MPS5501b
PCL5e/PCL XL/PS3 emulation/
PDF emulation/XPS/SIDM
Automatic
PCL Roman
(Bitmap)
Line Printer/OCR-A
PCL Roman
(Scalable)
87 fonts
PCL Heisei
(Scalable)
No
PS Roman
(Scalable)
136 fonts
PS Heisei
(Scalable)
No
RAM
Hard disk
Tray configuration
Cassette
Other
High-speed USB
Ethernet
Host USB
Wireless LAN (Wireless Model only)
Centronics interface (Parallel installed Model only)
Standard
Barcode
computational
Yes (Face-down)
Paper thickness
detect
45487001TH Rev.1
Font
No
Toner low
Item
Emulation switch
Yes
Yes
Communication
interface
Emulation
3 LEDs (green 2, amber 1)
MPT paper end
Stacker full
Classifi-cation
UPC-A, UPC-E, EAN/JAN-8, EAN/JAN-13, Interleaved
2of5, Code39, Code128, EAN/UCC-128, CODABAR,
ZIP+4 POSTNET, PDF417, 2D QR Barcode
512MB DIMM
160 GB
2nd/3rd/4th/LCF
Universal (530 sheets, 80g/m2)
Base on casters
Yes
USB-IF logo
Yes
Windows logo
Yes
Operation with
UPS or inverter
Operations on UPS (uninterruptible power supply) are
not guaranteed.
Do not use UPS.
1-7 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.5 Interface specifications
1.5.1 USB interface specifications
1.5.1.1 USB interface overview
(Shielded USB 2.0 cables shall be used.)
USB (Hi-Speed USB supported)
1.5.1.3 USB interface signals
(2) Transmission mode
Full speed (Max. 12 Mbps 0.25%)
High speed (Max. 480 Mbps 0.05%)
Signal name
(3) Power control
Length: USB 2.0 cables no more than five meters long (two meters or less
recommended)
(1) Basic specifications
(2) Cables
Self-powered device
1.5.1.2 USB interface connectors and cables
Function
Vbus
Power (+5V)
D-
For data transfer
D+
For data transfer
GND
Shell
Shield
Signal ground
(1) Connector
Printer side:
B-receptacle (female)
Upstream port
UBB-4R-D14C-4D(LF)SN (JST Mfg. Co.,Ltd) or equivalent
Connector pin arrangement
Cable side:
45487001TH Rev.1
B-plug (male)
1-8 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.5.2 Network interface specifications
1.5.2.3 Network interface signals
(1) 10/100Base-T
1.5.2.1 Network interface overview
Basic specifications
Pin No.
Signal name
Direction
Function
TXD+
FROM PRINTER
Transmission data +
TXD-
FROM PRINTER
Transmission data -
RXD+
TO PRINTER
Receive data +
TCP, UDP
Not use
Application layer
Not use
RXD-
TO PRINTER
Receive data -
Not use
Not use
TCP/IP spec. Network layer
ARP, IPv4, IPv6, ICMP, ICMPv6, IPSec
Transport layer
LPR, Port9100, FTP, HTTP, HTTPS, IPP, SNMPv1/v3, TELNET,
DHCP/BOOTP, DNS, DDNS, WINS, UPnP, Bonjour, SNTP, SMTP,
ODNSP, Windows Rally (WSD Print, PnP-X, LLTD)
NBT:
NetBIOS over TCP
IEEE 802.1X: EAP-TLS, PEAP
(2) 1000Base-T
1.5.2.2 Network interface connector and cable
Pin No.
Signal name
Direction
Function
(1) Connector
TRD+(0)
bi-direction
Data0+ transmission and reception
1000BASE-T/100BASE-TX/10BASE-T
TRD-(0)
Data0-transmission and reception
(Auto switch, cannot be used simultaneously)
TRD+(1)
Data1+ transmission and reception
TRD+(2)
Data2+ transmission and reception
TRD-(2)
Data2-transmission and reception
TRD-(1)
Data1- transmission and reception
TRD+(3)
Data3+ transmission and reception
TRD-(3)
Data3-transmission and reception
Connector pins arrangement
(2) Cable
Non-shield twisted-pair cable with RJ-45 connector
(Category 5e is recommended)
45487001TH Rev.1
1-9 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.5.3 USB host interface specifications
1.5.3.1 USB host interface overview
1.5.4.1 Wireless LAN interface overview
(1) Basic Specification
USB
(1) Specification
(2) Transmission Mode
Hi Speed (480 Mbps 0.05 % max.)
Max. 500 mA
USB Micro B
(3) Power supply voltage
(4) Connection devices
IEEE802.11 b/g/n (2.4GHz)
(2) Power connector
(3) Supply Power
1.5.4 Wireless LAN interface specifications (Wireless
Model only)
USB memory
5V
(4) Printer side interface
1.5.3.2 USB host interface connector
IEEE802.3u 10/100BASE (LAN port)
USB A plug connector
USB Micro B
Chip Antena
X: Do not connect.
(Blue)
LAN Port
(Yellow)
Connector pin arrangement
Note! This product cannot connect to a wired LAN and wireless LAN at the same
time.
1.5.3.3 USB host interface signals
1
Name of Signal
Function
Vbus
Power Supply (+5V)(red)
D-
Data transmission (white)
D+
Data transmission (green)
GND
Single ground (black)
Shell
Shield
45487001TH Rev.1
1-10 /
1. Configuration
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
1.5.5 Parallel interface specifications (Parallel installed
Model only)
1.5.5.1 Parallel interface overview
Pin No.
Signal name
Signal
direction
Compatible
Nibble
ECP
14
AUTO FEED
PR
nAutoFd
HostBusy
HostAck
15
Logic Gnd
Chassis Gnd
16
Item
Details
17
Supported modes
Compatible mode, nibble mode, ECP mode
Data bit length
Compatible mode: 8 bit, Nibble mode: 4 bit, ECP mode: 9 bit
1.5.5.2 Parallel interface connector and cable
(1) Connector
Printer: 36-pole connector (female)
Product equivalent to RS6-36SKAAB4L00 (FU-YAO Tec. Co.,ltd.)
18
36
19
Connector pin arrangement
0V
CHASSIS
GROUND
18
+5V
PR
Peripheral Logic High
19
0V
Signal Ground (nStrobe)
20-27
0V
Signal Ground (Data 1-8)
28
0V
Signal Ground (Perror,Select,nAck)
29
0V
Signal Ground (Busy,nFault)
30
0V
31
INPUT PRIME
PR
32
FAULT
PR
Signal Ground (nAutoFd,nSelectIn,nInit)
nReversenInit
nInit
Request
nPeriphnFault
nDataAvail
Request
33
0V
34
35
Hi Level
PR
Pulled up to +5V through 3.3Kohm
36
SEL-IN
PR
nSelectIn
1284 Active
1284 Active
Cable: 36-pole connector (male)
(2) Cable
1.5.5.4 Parallel interface levels
Use a cable of 1.8 m or less.
(Use a shielded twisted-pair cable for noise prevention.)
Low level: 0.0V to +0.8V
High level: +2.4V to +5.0V
1.5.5.3 Parallel interface signals
Signal name
Signal
direction
DATA STROBE
2-9
DATA BIT - n
10
ACKNOWLEDGE
Pin No.
Compatible
Nibble
ECP
PR
nStrobe
HostClk
HostClk
PR
Data 1 (LSB) - 8 (MSB)
PR
nAck
PtrClk
PeriphClk
11
BUSY
PR
Busy
PtrBusy
PeriphAck
12
PAPER END
PR
Perror
AckDataReq
nAckReverse
13
SELECT
PR
Select
Xflag
Xflag
45487001TH Rev.1
1-11 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2. Installation
2.1 Cautions, and do's and don'ts.....................................................2-2
2.2 Unpacking procedure..................................................................2-3
2.3 Printer installation instructions.....................................................2-4
2.4 List of components and accessories...........................................2-5
2.5 Assembly procedure....................................................................2-6
2.6 Printing of the configuration report............................................2-28
2.7 Connetion methods...................................................................2-29
2.8 Checking of paper used by user................................................2-39
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.1 Cautions, and do's and don'ts
Do not install the printer in any high-temperature location or a near heat source.
Do not install the printer in a location where chemical reaction may occur (laboratory
and the like).
Do not install the printer in the proximity of inflammable solvents, such as alcohol
and paint thinner.
Do not install the printer within reach of children.
Do not install the printer on an unstable surface (e.g., on a rickety bench or on a
slanting place).
Do not install the printer in a location with moisture or heavy dust, or in direct sun.
Do not install the printer in an environment with sea wind or corrosive gas.
Do not install the printer in a location with heavy vibration.
In the event that the printer is inadvertently dropped or its cover is damaged, remove
the power plug from the power outlet and contact the customer information center.
Such mishap could lead to an electric shock, fire or injury.
Do not connect any power cord, printer cable or grounding wire in any other manner
than the way specified in the manual. Failure to observe the above could result in
fire.
Do not stick in an object into the vent hole.
Such action could lead to an electric shock, fire or injury.
Do not place a glass filled with water or the like on the printer.
Such action could lead to an electric shock or fire.
When the printer cover is opened, be careful not to touch the fuser unit.
It may cause burns.
Do not throw the toner cartridges or the image drum cartridges into fire.
Dust explosion could cause burns.
Do not use a highly combustible spray near the printer.
It may cause a fire because the printer contains parts that get extremely hot.
In the event that the cover becomes unusually hot, emits smoke, bad smell, or
abnormal noise, remove the power plug from the power outlet and contact the
customer information center.
It may lead a fire.
45487001TH Rev.1
If water or any other liquid enters the inside of the printer, remove the power plug
from the power outlet and contact Customer Center.
Fire could break out.
If someone drops foreign objects such as a clip in the printer, remove the power plug
from the outlet and take out the foreign objects.
It may cause an electric shock, fire, or injury.
Do not operate or disassemble the printer in any other manner than the way
specified in the manual.
Failure to observe this warning could result in an electric shock, fire or injury.
Do not install the printer in a location where its vent hole is blocked.
Do not install the printer directly on a shag carpet or rug.
Do not install the printer in a sealed room or other location with poor ventilation or
permeability.
Make sure to ventilate sufficiently when continuously using the printer in a small
room for a long time.
Install the printer away from a strong magnetic field or noise source.
Install the printer away from a monitor or TV.
To move the printer, hold both sides of the printer.
This printer, which weighs approximately 27 kg, should be lifted by two or more
people.
While the printer power is on or the printer is printing, do not come close to the
paper exit. Such action could lead to injury.
When the precautionary notes concerning the installation and operation are explained,
the user should be referred to the precautionary notes given in the users manual.
Especially, give thorough explanation on the power cord and the grounding wire.
2-2 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.2 Unpacking procedure
Personal injuries may occur.
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted
by two or more people.
Remove the four handles from the sides of the box, as illustrated below,
and lift the corrugated fiberboard box.
Handle
(one on each side:
four in total)
45487001TH Rev.1
2-3 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.3 Printer installation instructions
Install the printer in a location where the following temperature and humidity are met:
Ambient temperature:
10 - 32C
Ambient humidity:
20 - 80 % RH (relative humidity)
Plan view
Maximum wet-bulb temperature: 25C
20 cm
Exercise caution to avoid dew condensation.
If the printer is installed in a location with ambient relative humidity below 30%, use a
humidifier or antistatic mat.
Installation space
Place the printer on a flat desk large enough to accommodate its footings.
Provide enough spaces around the printer.
100 cm
60 cm
20 cm
Side view
70 cm
45487001TH Rev.1
2-4 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.4 List of components and accessories
Check to make sure that the components are free from damage, dirt or other
irregularities in their appearance.
Ensure that none of the accessories to the components is missing and that they are
free from breakage or other flaw.
Printer software DVD-ROM
AC cable
Note! No printer cable is supplied with the printer.
If any irregularity is discovered, contact the user management section for instructions.
Personal injury may occur.
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted by two or more people.
Printer (main unit)
Print cartridge
Note! The starter toner cartridges are installed in the image drums.
The image drums are installed in the printer at the time of shipping.
The print cartridge for the ES7131/MPS5501b is divided into an image drum
and a toner cartridge.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-5 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.5 Assembly procedure
2.5.1 Assembly of the printer main unit
Unpacking
(3) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the
front cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Note! Open the front cover gently. If you open it rapidly, the MP Tray may open.
Personal injury may occur.
Front cover
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted by two or more people.
Note! Be sure to use the consumables or maintenance units provided with this
printer at first. Otherwise, the life of the consumables or maintenance units
may not be displayed correctly, or you may not be able to use them later.
The print cartridge (the green tube) is very delicate. Handle it carefully.
Do not expose the print cartridge to direct sunlight or very bright interior
light (approximately more than 1500 lux). Even under the normal interior
light, do not leave it for more than 5 minutes.
Packaging and cushioning material are needed if transporting the printer.
Do not throw them away.
(1) Remove your printer from the box and remove all cushioning materials and the
plastic bag from your printer.
Front cover open lever
(4) For the ES7131/MPS5501b, remove the protective tape and orange stopper.
Stopper
Protection tape
Stopper
(2) Remove the two strips of protective tape on the right side and at the back of your
printer.
(5) Turn the blue lever of the print cartridge fully in the direction of the arrow.
Lever(blue)
Protective tape
45487001TH Rev.1
2-6 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6) Open the top cover.
(8) Close the top cover.
Top cover
(7) Pull out the orange stopper from the fuser unit.
(9) Close the front cover.
Stopper
45487001TH Rev.1
2-7 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Set the paper into Trays 1/2/3/4.
(3) Slide the paper guide and paper stopper to the size of paper to be loaded.
Paper stopper
Note! This procedure images use tray 1 as an example, but the same procedure
applies to trays 2/3/4.
(1) Pull out the paper tray.
Paper guide
(4) Flex paper back and forth, and then fan it. Straighten the edges of the paper
stack on a level surface.
Paper tray
(5) Load paper with the print side face down and press it from above.
Note! Do not load paper exceeding the mark of the paper guide.
(2) Display the size of the paper to be loaded on the indicator then insert the
indicator.
Mark
Indicator
(6) Return the paper tray to the printer.
Note! If you load paper whose size cannot be selected with the paper size
indicator options, set the paper size on the operator panel.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-8 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(3) Tilt the paper jam release lever of the fuser unit back to the envelope position.
Set the paper in MP tray.
Note! Do not load paper of different sizes, types, or weights at the same time.
When adding paper, remove the paper on the MP Tray and straighten the
edges of both stacks of paper, and then load them again.
Do not put anything other than paper for printing in the MP Tray.
Possible to get burned.
Do not touch the fuser unit. It is hot.
Paper jam release lever
Preparation before setting envelopes in the MP Tray.
Before setting envelopes in the MP Tray, perform the following procedure.
(1) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
Front cover open lever
(2) Open the top cover.
(4) Close the top cover.
Top cover
45487001TH Rev.1
2-9 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Close the front cover.
Setting the paper
(1) Open the MP Tray forward by inserting your fingers into the front recesses.
MP tray
(2) Pull out the paper support by holding the center part of it.
Note! When loading envelopes in the MP Tray, load them face up with the
orientation noted below.
- C5, C6, DL, Com-9, Com-10 and Monarch are loaded with the flap
folded, with the orientation shown in the figure below.
Paper support
(3) Unfold the sub support.
Sub support
45487001TH Rev.1
2-10 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(4) Open the paper set cover.
(7) Close the paper set cover.
Paper set cover
Paper set cover
(5) Adjust the manual feeding paper guide to the width of paper to be loaded.
Manual feeding paper guide
(6) Insert the paper with the print side face up.
Note! Do not load paper exceeding the mark of the paper guide.
45487001TH Rev.1
Mark
2-11 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.5.2 Connection of the AC cable
Power supply conditions
Turning on the power
(1) Plug the AC cable into the AC power socket of your printer.
Observe the following conditions:
Current:
110 - 127 VAC (Range 99 - 140 VAC)
220 - 240 VAC (Range 198 - 264 VAC)
Frequency: 50/60 Hz 2%
If the power supply is unstable, use a voltage regulator.
The maximum power consumption of this printer is 1400 W. Ensure that the power
supply is sufficient to operate this printer.
We do not guarantee operation where an uninterruptible power system (UPS) or
inverter is used. Do not use an uninterruptible power system (UPS) or inverter.
AC cable
There is a risk of getting an electric
shock and/or causing fire.
Be sure to turn off the power supply switch when attaching or removing the AC cable.
Be sure to plug in and unplug the AC cable while holding on to the power supply plug.
Insert the AC cable plug completely into the wall socket securely.
Do not touch the power cable, or printer, if your hands are wet.
Install a power cable in the place which is not stepped on, and do not place a thing on a
power cable.
Do not use the cable tied in a bundle.
Please do not use the damaged power cable.
Do not use multi-outlet adapters.
Do not connect this printer and other electric products to the same wall socket. If it is
connected simultaneously with an air conditioner, copier, shredder, etc., the printer
may malfunction by the electric noise. When you connect with the same wall socket
unavoidably, please use a commercial noise filter or a commercial noise cut transformer.
Use the power cable supplied to the printer and plug it directly into a wall socket. Do not
use the power cable for other product for the printer.
Do not use an extension cable. When you use it unavoidably, use the thing more than
rated 15 A.
Use of an extended code may not operate a printer normally by AC voltage descent.
During printing, do not shut off a power supply or do not pull out a power supply plug.
When you use it neither for consecutive holidays nor a travel for a long time, pull out a
power cable.
Do not use the supplied power cable to the other products.
(2) Plug the AC cable into the electric socket.
(3) Hold down the power switch for about 1 second to turn on the power.
Power switch
The Power switch LED indicator lights up when the printer turns on. The message Ready
To Print is displayed in the operator panel once printer is ready.
About the connections of the power cable and grounding wire, the user should be given
thorough explanation on the basis of the users manual.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-12 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Turning off the power
(1) Hold down the power switch for about 1 second.
The message Shutting down/Please wait. Printer will turn off automatically.
appears in the operator panel, and the power switch indicator blinks every 1
second. Then the printer turns off automatically and the power switch indicator goes
out.
When the Printer is Not Used for a Long Time
When the printer is not used for a long time due to consecutive holidays or when on vacation,
or when changing or attaching parts in repair or maintenance, unplug the AC cable.
Note! The printer will not be functionally impaired even if left unplugged for a long
time (more than 4 weeks).
Power switch
Note! It may take about 5 minutes for the printer to shut itself off. Wait until it turns
off.
Holding down the power switch for more than 5 seconds turns off printer
forcibly. Only perform this procedure when a problem occurs.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-13 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.5.3 Installation and recognition confirmation of options
Printer and three additional tray units
(1) Installation of an Additional Tray Unit
An additional tray unit is intended for increasing the amount of paper that can be loaded in
the printer, and three additional tray units can be installed to the printer. An additional tray
holds 530 sheets of 70 kg paper, allowing the printer to print up to 2,220 sheets continuously
when used with a standard paper cassette and a multi-purpose tray together.
Printer and one additional tray unit
1. Turn off your printer, then unplug all the cables from the printer.
Turn off the printer by following the steps described under Turning off the power in
section 3.5.2.
2. Stack the additional trays, inserting the projections of the lower additional tray into
the holes on the bottom of the upper additional tray one by one.
Printer and two additional tray units
Projection
45487001TH Rev.1
2-14 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3. Gently place the printer on the additional trays, inserting the projections of the
additional tray into the holes on the bottom of the printer.
Never push down the cassette while it is open.
Personal injury may occur.
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted by two or more people.
Projection
Never push the printer from behind it while the cassette is open.
Personal injury may occur.
For prevention of overturning of the printer during transport or maintenance, be
sure not to do the following:
Never push the top cover of the printer while it is open.
4. Plug the AC cable and removed cables into your printer, and then turn on the power
switch.
Note! If [SERVICE CALL 182: ERROR 183: ERROR 184: ERROR] appears,
remove the installed tray unit and reinstall it to the printer.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-15 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Set the number of trays in the printer driver.
Setting should be made in the printer driver to have the printer recognize every
added tray.
If the printer driver hasnt been set up, set up the printer driver by referring to the
relevant users manual (Setup) and then perform the following setup.
Note! Administrator privileges on the computer are required.
Settings for Windows PS printer driver
Click [Start] and select [Devices and
Printers].
Right-click the [printer name (PS)] icon
then select [Printer Properties]. (If you
have installed multiple printer drivers,
select [Printer Properties] then [printer
name (PS)].)
Select the [Device Options] tab.
Settings for Windows PCL printer driver
Click [Start] and select [Devices and
Printers].
Right-click the printer icon then select
[Printer Proper ties]. (If you have
installed multiple printer drivers, select
[Printer Properties] then [printer name
(PCL)].)
Select the [Device Options] tab.
For the network connection, select [Get
Printer Settings]. For USB connection,
enter the number of trays except the
multipurpose tray in [Installed Paper
Trays].
Click [OK].
For network connection, Select [Get
installed options automatically] in
[Installable Options] and click [Setup].
Fo r U S B c o n n e c t i o n , s e l e c t a n
appropriate value in [Available Trays] of
[Installable Options].
Click [OK].
Settings for Windows XPS printer driver
Click [Start] and select [Devices and
Printers].
Right-click the printer icon then select
[Printer Proper ties]. (If you have
installed multiple printer drivers, select
[Printer Properties] then [printer name
(XPS)].)
Select the [Device Options] tab.
For the network connection, select [Get
Printer Settings]. For USB connection,
enter the number of trays except the
multipurpose tray in [Installed Paper
Trays].
Click [OK].
45487001TH Rev.1
2-16 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Settings for Mac OS X PS printer driver (Mac OS X 10.5 to 10.8)
(2) Installation of a printer stand
Select [System Preference] from the
Apple Menu.
Click [Print & Fax].
Select a printer and click [Options &
Supplies].
Select the [Driver] tab.
Select an appropriate value in [Available
Trays] and click [OK].
Settings for Mac OS X PS printer driver (Mac OS X 10.4.11)
Attaching a set of anti-tip feet
Select [Utilities] from [GO] menu and double click [Printer Setup Utility].
Select the printer to click [Show Info].
Select [Installable Options] from the pop-up menu under the printer name.
Select an appropriate value in [Available Trays], and then, click [Apply Changes].
Close the Printer Information.
Anti-tip Foot
Side (2)
Anti-tip Foot
Cover (2)
Anti-tip Foot
(2)
Anti-tip Foot
Rear (2)
Anti-tip Foot
Cover (2)
Screws (22)
1. Attach the anti-tip feet (both sides and front) with four screws.
Note! Attachment directions are different for the left side and the right side.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-17 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2. Put the bottoms of the anti-tip feet (both sides) on the floor, align the sides to the
cabinet and tighten them with the two screws each.
3. Tighten the anti-tip foot covers (both sides) and anti-tip feet with two screws each.
Screw hole
Note! Do not tighten the upper screw holes.
Screw hole
When you tighten the bottom screws, attach the anti-tip foot to the locatoin
where a screw does not incline.
* You can attach the screws to Case1 and Case2. As the screw inclines
when you tighten the screw in Case3, lift the anti-tip foot and attach the
screw to Case2.
45487001TH Rev.1
Case 1
Case 2
Case 3
OK
OK
NG
4. Align the anti-tip foot cover (rear) to the rear side of the anti-tip foot.
2-18 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Put the bottoms of the anti-tip feet on the floor and tighten them with three screws.
Attaching a printer stand to the printer
Personal injury may occur.
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted by two or more people.
1. Turn off your printer, then unplug all the cables from the printer.
Turn off the printer by following the steps described under Turning off the power in
section 3.5.2.
2. Gently place the printer on the printer stand, inserting the projections of the printer
stand into the holes on the bottom of the printer.
Attach the screw in the middle of the oval cutout and tighten the screw.
Projection
3. Plug the AC cable and removed cables into your printer, and then turn on the power
switch.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-19 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Attaching a printer stand to an additional tray (trays 2/3/4)
Stack the additional trays one by one on the printer stand then place the printer on them.
1. Gently place the additional tray on the printer stand, inserting the four projections of
the printer stand into the holes on the bottom of the additional tray.
3. Turn off your printer, then unplug all the cables from the printer.
Turn off the printer by following the steps described under Turning off the power in
section 3.5.2.
4. Gently place the printer on the additional trays, inserting the projections of the
additional tray into the holes on the bottom of the printer.
Personal injury may occur.
Since the printer weights approximately 27 kg, it should be lifted by two or more people.
Projection
2. To add more additional trays, gently place them on the additional tray, inserting the
projections of the lower additional tray into the holes on the bottom of the upper
additional tray one by one.
Projection
Projection
45487001TH Rev.1
2-20 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Lock the two casters on the front side of the additional trays, by pushing down their
lock levers.
Never push down the cassette while it is open.
Personal injury may occur.
For prevention of overturning of the printer during transport or maintenance, be
sure not to do the following:
Never push the printer from behind it while the cassette is open.
Never push the top cover of the printer while it is open.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-21 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(3) Installation of an additional RAM
3. Loosen the screw to remove the metal plate.
Install additional RAM to increase the memory capacity of your printer in cases such as if
memory overflow or the collate print errors occur. Your printer supports 512 MB RAM.
Additional RAM
Metal plate
Note! Use only genuine Oki Data products. The performance cannot be
guaranteed when other products are used.
The static electricity may cause damage to the parts. Discharge the static
electricity in your body by touching grounded metallic parts, etc. before
work.
Components may be damaged by static electricity. Make sure to remove
the static electricity charged on human body by touching metals by hand
before works.
4. Make sure the LED indicated by the arrow is unlit. If it is lit, wait until it turns off.
Memo For banner printing, installing additional memory is recommended.
1. Turn off your printer, then unplug all the cables from the printer.
Turn off the printer by following the steps described under Turning off the power in
section 3.5.2.
LED
2. Open the access cover on the right side of the printer.
Access cover
45487001TH Rev.1
2-22 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Insert the additional RAM into the slot and fix it by pushing it toward the printer.
Note! Be careful of the orientation of the additional RAM. The additional RAM has
small dents on its connector, which are to be fitted with a connector of a
slot.
7. Close the access cover.
Access cover
Additional RAM
8. Plug the AC cable and removed cables into your printer, and then turn on the power
switch.
9. Set up with the operator panel.
6. Insert the right side of the metal plate into the printer, close it, then secure it by
tightening the screw.
Press the scroll button
operator panel.
on the
Check that [Configuration] is selected
then press the <ENTER> button.
Metal plate
Press the scroll button
several
times to select [System] then press the
<ENTER> button.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-23 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Press the scroll button
several
times to select [RAM] then press the
<ENTER> button.
Check that the value of [RAM] has
increased.
For memory expanded to 512 MB, it is
[768 MB].
Note! If the value of [RAM] has not
increased, turn off your printer
and unplug the AC cable and
all the cables, and then reinstall
the additional RAM.
(4) Installation of a Hard Disk
1. Turn off your printer, then unplug all the cables from the printer.
Turn off the printer by following the steps described under Turning off the power in
section 3.5.2.
2. Open the access cover on the right side of the printer.
Access cover
Press the <ON LINE> button.
3. Loosen the screw to remove the metal plate.
Metal plate
45487001TH Rev.1
2-24 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4. Make sure the LED indicated by the arrow is unlit. If it is lit, wait until it turns off.
7. Insert the right side of the metal plate into the printer, close it, then secure it by
tightening the screw.
LED
Metal plate
5. Attach a hard disk, and fasten two screws to secure it.
8. Close the access cover.
HDD
6. Plug the white connector of the hard disk first into the printer then plug the other
connector into the printer.
Connector (white)
Access cover
Connector (black)
9. Plug the AC cable and removed cables into your printer, and then turn on the power
switch.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-25 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
10. Set up with the operator panel.
Press the <ON LINE> button.
Press the scroll button
operator panel.
on the
Check that [Configuration] is selected
then press the <ENTER> button.
Press the scroll button
several
times to select [System] then press the
<ENTER> button.
Press the scroll button
several
times to select [HDD] then press the
<ENTER> button.
Check that the value of [HDD].
11. Set up [Hard Disk] in the printer driver.
Note! Administrator privileges on the computer are required.
The Hard Disk cannot be used with a Windows XPS driver and Mac PS
driver.
Setting for Windows PCL Printer Driver
Click [Start] and select [Devices and
Printers].
Right-click the printer icon then select
[Printer Proper ties]. (If you have
installed multiple printer drivers, select
[Printer Properties] then [printer name
(PCL)].)
Select the [Device Options] tab.
For the network connection, select [Get
Printer Settings]. For USB connection,
check the checkbox of [Printer Hard
Disk].
Click [OK].
Note! If [uninstalled] is displayed, turn
off your printer and unplug the
AC cable and all the cables, and
then reinstall the hard disk.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-26 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Settings for Windows PS printer driver
Click [Start] and select [Devices and
Printers].
Right-click the [printer name (PS)] icon
then select [Printer Properties]. (If you
have installed multiple printer drivers,
select [Printer Properties] then [printer
name (PS)].)
Select the [Device Options] tab.
For network connection, Select [Get
Printer Settings] in [Installable Options]
and click [Setup]. For USB connection,
set the [Hard Disk] of [Installable
Options] to [Installed].
Click [OK].
45487001TH Rev.1
2-27 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2. Installation
2.6 Printing of the configuration report
Check that you can print with the printer. Check the detailed settings and status of your
printer by printing the contents of the settings (Menu Map).
Note! When the printer is in power saving mode, press the <POWER SAVE>
button to restore from the mode.
(1) Set A4 paper in tray.
(2) Press the <Fn> key on the operator panel.
(3) Enter 100 using the ten-key pad, then press the <ENTER> button.
(4) Press the <ENTER> button as [Execute] is selected.
After finishing a print of printer settings, check that the added options are properly
indicated. Setup for printing from a printer completes if the options have been properly
added.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-28 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.7 Connection methods
<USB connection>
Note! Refer to the users manual for operating environment.
1. Prepare a USB cable.
Note! No USB cable is supplied with this printer. Procure a USB cable with the
USB2.0 specifications separately.
To use Hi-Speed mode of USB2.0, a USB cable with the Hi-Speed
specifications is required.
A USB 2.0 cable to be used must be no more than five meters long. A USB
cable of two meters or less is recommended.
3. Connect the USB cable.
(1) Plug one end of the USB cable into the USB interface connection of the printer.
(2) Plug the other end of the USB cable into the USB interface connection of the
computer.
Note! Be careful not to plug the USB cable into the network interface connection.
It may cause a malfunction.
2. Turn off the printer and the computer.
Memo Although a USB cable can be plugged in or unplugged with the computer
and the printer switched on, for secure installation of the USB driver and
the printer driver to be performed subsequently, the printer should be
turned off.
45487001TH Rev.1
Memo For the setup procedure of the printer driver, see the users manual.
2-29 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
<Parallel connection> (Models with the parallel interface connection only)
Note! Refer to the users manual for operating environment.
1. Prepare a parallel cable.
Note! A parallel cable is not supplied with the printer. Procure one separately.
<Ethernet cable connection>
Note! Refer to the users manual for operating environment.
1. Prepare an Ethernet cable and a hub.
Note! An Ethernet cable and a hub are not supplied with this printer. Prepare an
Ethernet cable (category 5e, twisted pair, straight) and a hub separately.
<Ethernet cable>
<Hub>
2. Turn off the printer and the computer.
3. Connect the parallel cable.
(1) Plug one end of the parallel cable into the parallel interface connection of the
printer.
(2) Plug the other end of the parallel cable into the parallel interface connection of the
computer
2. Turn off the printer and the computer.
3. Connect the computer to the printer.
(1) Plug one end of the Ethernet cable into the network interface connection of the
printer.
(2) Plug the other end of the Ethernet cable into the hub.
Memo For the setup procedure of the printer driver, see the users manual.
45487001TH Rev.1
Memo If there is DHCP server on the network to which this printer is to be
connected, the IP address will be automatically obtained on the printer
each time it is turned on. If the IP address of this printer is changed,
perform the network setting again. With OKI LPR utility, the network
setting will be automatically performed if the IP address of this printer is
changed. For details, refer to Users Manual (Advanced).
For the setup procedure of the printer driver, see the users manual.
2-30 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
<Wireless LAN connection> (Wireless Model only)
Note! Refer to the users manual for operating environment.
1. Check the Wireless LAN environment.
5. If the access point of the wireless LAN checked in step 1 supports
WPS, the printer is automatically connected. Go to WPS-PBC.
If it does not support WPS, you must enter the setting data for the wireless LAN on the
printer manually. Go to Configuring manually.
Check whether the access point of the wireless LAN supports WPS or not by referring
to the instruction manual for the access point of the Wireless LAN.
If it supports WPS: The printer is automatically connected.
If it does not support WPS: The setting data for the wireless LAN must be
entered on the printer manually.
Note! This product supports infrastructure mode. Ad-hoc mode is not supported.
Be sure to prepare the access point.
This printer supports Wireless LAN Standard IEEE 802.1b/g/n. It does not
support IEEE 802.11a. The access point must operate with the Wireless
LAN Standard supported by this printer.
This product cannot connect to a wired LAN and wireless LAN at the same
time. To connect to the wireless LAN, remove the network cable from this
product.
2. Check that the access point of the wireless LAN is turned on and is
operating normally.
Terminology
SSID
An ID used to identify the connection destination network. Wireless
communications can be used by setting this product with the SSID of the
connection destination wireless access point.
Security Settings
When using a wireless LAN, security settings can be configured to prevent
the transmitted information from being intercepted or illegal access to the
network. The security settings need to be configures to the same settings
as the wireless access point.
WPS
A wireless LAN setting method provided by Wi-Fi Alliance, a wireless LAN
industry group. There are two available methods, a push button method and
PIN code method, and in the push button method the wireless LAN settings
can easily be configured simply by pressing a [WPS] button on the wireless
access point. In the PIN code method, the wireless LAN settings can easily
be configured by registering the 8-digit number assigned to this product to
the wireless access point.
Infrastructure mode
This mode communicates through the wireless access point. This product
does not support the ad-hoc mode in which communication is performed
directly with the computer.
3. Place the printer near the access point of the wireless LAN.
For the accessible distance between the printer and the access point of the wireless
LAN, refer to the operation manual for the access point of the wireless LAN.
4. Turn on the printer.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-31 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Check that [WPS-PBC] is selected and then press the <ENTER> button.
WPS-PBC
(1) Press the scroll button
button.
to select [Wireless Setting] and then press the <ENTER>
(6) Select [Yes] and then press the <ENTER> button.
(2) Enter the administrator password using the ten-key pad, then press the <ENTER>
button.
The factory default password is aaaaaa. Press the <ENTER> button whenever
inputting one character.
Memo If [No] is selected, the screen returns to that from step 5.
(7) When [Running pushbutton method] is displayed, press and hold the push button
on the access point of the Wireless LAN for several seconds then release it.
(3) When the display shown below appears, read it carefully. Press the <ENTER>
button or wait until the display changes.
(4) Check that [Automatic Setup (WPS)] is selected and then press the <ENTER>
button.
45487001TH Rev.1
Note! [Running pushbutton method] is displayed for about two minutes. Press
and hold the push button on the access point of the Wireless LAN while it is
displayed.
For the position of the push button on the access point of the Wireless LAN
and how long it should be held pressed, refer to the operation manual for
the access point of the Wireless LAN.
While [Running pushbutton method] is displayed, the printer cannot be
operated.
When [WPS Connection successful is displayed, this equipment is
connected to the wireless LAN.
2-32 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Memo If [Timeout] is displayed, it is possible that the access point of the
connection destination could not be found within the time limit. Redo from
step 6.
If [Overlap] is displayed, WPS-push button is being executed on 2 or more
access points. Please wait for a short time and then retry.
WPS-PIN
(1) Press the scroll button
button.
to select [Wireless Setting] and then press the <ENTER>
(2) Enter the administrator password using the ten-key pad, then press the <ENTER>
button.
The factory default password is aaaaaa. Press the <ENTER> button whenever
inputting one character.
(3) When the display shown below appears, read it carefully. Press the <ENTER>
button or wait until the display changes.
(4) Check that [Automatic Setup (WPS)] is selected and then press the <ENTER>
button.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-33 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Press the scroll button
to select [WPS-PIN] and then press the <ENTER> button.
(6) Set the 8-character PIN code displayed on the display screen on the access point
and start WPS-PIN.
Note! After pressing the button, immediately perform step 7.
The PIN code input method and WPS-PIN starting method differ depending
on the access point. For details, refer to the instruction manual for the
access point.
(7) Select [Yes] and then press the <ENTER> button.
(8) [Implementing PIN method] is displayed on the screen.
Note! Panel operations cannot be performed during WPS execution.
When [Connection successful] is displayed, this equipment is connected to
the wireless LAN.
Memo If [Timeout] is displayed, it is possible that the access point of the connection
destination could not be found within the time limit. After entering the PIN code
from this equipment into the access point and starting WPS-PIN, select [Yes]
in step 7 again within 2 minutes.
Memo If [No] is selected, the screen returns to that from step 5. Each time the
confirmation screen is displayed, the PIN code is automatically generated and
changed.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-34 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Configuring manually
(5) Press the scroll button
to select [SSID] and then press the <ENTER> button.
(1) Check and write down the SSID, encryption scheme, and cryptography key.
You can check the SSID, encryption scheme, and cryptography key in the
instruction manual for the access point of the Wireless LAN.
Note! It is necessary to set the same SSID, encryption scheme, and cryptography
key for the access point of the Wireless LAN on the printer.
The SSID, encryption scheme, and cryptography key are essential for the
Wireless LAN connection. Be sure to check them.
(2) Press the scroll button to select [Wireless Setting] and then press the <ENTER>
button.
Memo When the <ENTER> button is pressed, the screen switches to the security
settings screen in step 3 without switching to the screen in step 4. If the SSID
is not set, a warning screen is displayed.
(6) Enter the SSID checked in step 1, using the ten-key pad.
Memo Symbols such as _ (underscore) are entered using the * key.
Note! Characters are case sensitive. Enter them correctly.
(7) Once you have finished entering the characters, press the <ENTER> button.
(3) Enter the administrator password using the ten-key pad, then press the <ENTER>
button.
(8) Press the scroll button
to select [Security] and then press the <ENTER> button.
The factory default password is aaaaaa. Press the <ENTER> button whenever
inputting one character.
(4) Press the scroll button
button.
45487001TH Rev.1
to select [Manual Setup] and then press the <ENTER>
2-35 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(9)
Select the security type checked in step 1.
b) Enter the same Key as the WEP Key set for the access point that you want to
connect to.
Memo After entering the Key, the key is displayed as * symbols for security
reasons.
(10-2) When WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK is selected:
Memo The default is [Disable].
IDepending on the model of access point mixed WPAPSK/WPA2-PSK may
be supported. In this case, select the WPA2-PSK.
If WEP is selected, go to (10-1) When WEP is selected:.
Memo The default is [TKIP].
If the encryption scheme for the access point of the Wireless LAN is WPAPSK, select THIP. If it is WPA2- PSK, select AES.
If WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK is selected, go to (10-2) When WPA-PSK or WPA2PSK is selected:.
Memo Security settings (WPA-EAP/WPA2-EAP) using an authentication server
are also supported, but this can only be set from the Web. For details, refer
to Users Manual (Advanced). Depending on the security setting selected
in step 7, execute the settings from either (1) or (2) below. If [Disable] is
selected, proceed to step 11. (For security reasons, we do not recommend
setting [Disable].)
(10-1) When WEP is selected:
a) Press the <ENTER> button to select WPA Encryption Type and then press the
<ENTER> button.
b) Press the <ENTER> button on WPA Preshared key input screen.
a) Press the <ENTER> button on the WEP Key input screen.
Note! Characters are case sensitive. Enter them correctly.
c) Enter the same Key as the Pre-shared Key set for the access point that you
want to connect to.
Memo After entering the Key, the key is displayed as * symbols for security
reasons.
Note! There is not setting for the WEP Key index. The WEP Key index
communications with the access point as 1.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-36 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(11) In the confirmation screen, check the entered SSID and selected security settings.
If there are no problems, press the scroll button
the <ENTER> button.
to select [Yes] and then press
Reconnect to the wireless LAN
When the wireless is enabled, restart the wireless function. If a problem has
occurred in the access point communication or performance, the wireless function
can be restarted.
(If the wired is enabled, the wireless function is enabled with the configured wireless
settings.)
(1) Press the scroll button
button.
to select [Wireless Setting] and then press the <ENTER>
(12) [Searching for connection] is displayed on the screen.
When [Connection successful] is displayed, this equipment is connected to the
wireless LAN.
(2) Enter the administrator password using the ten-key pad, then press the <ENTER>
button.
The factory default password is aaaaaa. Press the <ENTER> button whenever
inputting one character.
Memo If [Timeout] is displayed, the connection destination access point may
not have been found within the specified time. Check that SSID, security
settings, and Key settings, and retry.
(3) Press the scroll button
<ENTER> button.
45487001TH Rev.1
to select [Wireless reconnection] and then press the
2-37 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2. Installation
(4) Select [Yes] and then press the <ENTER> button.
(5) When [Yes] is selected in step 4, [Searching for connection] is displayed on the
screen.
After this, [Connection successful] is displayed, and the wireless LAN can be used
on this equipment.
Memo If [Timeout] is displayed, the connection destination access point may not
have been found within the specified time. The SSID, security settings, and
Key need to be configured to match the access point settings.
Check each of the settings. For details on each of the setting items, refer to
List of Setup Menu in the Users Manual (Advanced).
45487001TH Rev.1
2-38 /
2. Installation
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
2.8 Checking of paper used by the user
Load the media used by the user in the printer, make media weight/media type settings,
execute configuration/demo printing, and check the printout to make sure that no toner flakes
off.
Settings on the control panel
Type
Plain
paper*3
Paper weight
64 g/m2
Light
65 to 74g/m
75 to 87g/m2
88 to 104g/m
Plain
Light
Medium Light
Medium Light
Medium
Medium
Medium Heavy
Medium Heavy
105 to 120g/m
Heavy
Heavy
121 to 163g/m
Ultra heavy 1
Ultra heavy 1
Ultra heavy 2
Ultra heavy 2
Ultra heavy 3
164 to 220g/m
221 to 253g/m
Envelope*4
Label
Setting*2 for
[Media weight]
Media weight
Media type
of the printer
(paper thickness) (paper type)*1
driver
0.1 to under 0.17 mm
0.17 to 0.2 mm
Ultra heavy 3
Heavy
Labels
Label 1
Ultra heavy 1
Label 2
*1: The factory default for the media type is [Plain Paper].
*2: Media weight and type can be set on the operator panel and in the printer driver.
The settings in the printer driver take priority. Data is printed out in accordance with
the setting on the operator panel when [Auto selection] is selected in [Feed tray] or
[Printer setting] is selected in [Media weight].
*3: The weight of the paper supported for duplex print is 64-220g/m2.
*4: It is not necessary to set media weight and type for postcards and envelopes.
Memo Print speed decelerates when [Heavy], [Ultra heavy 1], [Ultra heavy 2], or
[Ultra heavy 3] of media weight or any value other than plain paper setting
value of media type is set.
45487001TH Rev.1
2-39 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3. Component replacement
In this chapter, the procedures for replacement of parts and assemblies and units are described.
The replacement procedure is described by removal of the parts. Please install the new parts with following the
replacement procedure in reverse order.
The parts (such as , )shown in this manual are different from the parts used in the Disassembly for
Maintenance figure (4548700TL) and RSPL (45487001TR).
3.1 Precautions on component replacement.....................................3-2
3.2 Method of component replacement.............................................3-4
3.3 Portions Lubricated....................................................................3-27
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.1 Precautions on component replacement
(2) Do not disassemble it if the printer works normally.
(1) Disconnect the AC cable and the interface cable before replacing the parts.
Turn off the printer, then the LED indicator goes out.
(3) Disassemble it as required. Do not remove the part that is not shown in the
replacement procedure.
Disconnect the AC plug from the AC power source outlet.
(4) Please use the specified maintenance tool.
Disconnect the AC cable and the interface cable from the printer.
(5) Disassemble it according to the proper procedure. It may cause damage to the
parts if disassemble it without following the proper procedure.
(a) Disconnect the AC cable according to the following procedure.
Warning
Risk of Electric Shock
(6) As the small parts such as the screws are lost easily, please fix them to the
original position temporarily.
There is a risk of electric shock during replacement of the low voltage power supply.
Use insulating gloves or avoid direct contact with any conducting part of the
power supply, and caution should be exercised during replacement.
The capacitor may take one minute to complete discharge after the AC cable
is unplugged. Also, there is a possibility that the capacitor doesnt discharge
because of a breakage of the PCB, etc., so remember the possibility of electric
shock to avoid electric shock.
(7) Do not use gloves that may cause static electricity easily when handling IC and
the circuit board such as microprocessor, ROM, and RAM.
(8) Do not put the PCB on the device and the floor directly.
(9) Do not work for a long time with the printer with the top cover open, and an
image drum unit installed in it.
(b) Reconnect the printer according to the following procedure.
Connect the AC cable and the interface cable to the printer.
Connect the AC plug to the AC power source outlet.
Turn on the printer, then the LED indicator goes on.
Disconnecting
Reconnecting
45487001TH Rev.1
3-2 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
[Maintenance tool]
The required tools for using the maintenance utility are shown in Table 4-1-2.
The required tools for replacing the PCB and the unit are shown in Table 4-1-1.
Table 4-1-2 required tools
No.
Table 4-1-1 Maintenance tools
No.
Maintenance tools
Amount
No. 2-200
Magnetic driver
No. 3-100 Driver
No. 5-200 Driver
Digital multimeter
Purpose
Note
3 - 5mm
Screw
Maintenance tools
Amount
Notebook computer
1
Please install
the maintenance
utility.
USB cable
Ethernet cable
(Cross cable)
Purpose
Note
Refer to the
chapter
5.2 for the
maintenance
utility.
Combination pliers
Handy cleaner (the
type corresponds to
the toner)
E Ring pliers
Refer to the
following note.
For E ring
detaching
Note! Use the specified cleaner corresponding to the toner. It may cause a fire
when using a general-purpose cleaner.
45487001TH Rev.1
3-3 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2 Method of component replacement
This section describes the procedure for replacing the parts and assemblies shown in the
disassembly diagram.
(3) Remove the ID unit .
Note! Cover the removed ID unit with paper so that it will not be exposed to light.
3.2.1 Transfer roller
(1) Open the front cover while pulling the front cover open lever.
Front cover
Front cover open lever
(2) Open the top cover.
(4) Remove the transfer roller by lifting up its left side.
Note! Operating carefully, not to touch transfer roller surface.
Top cover
45487001TH Rev.1
3-4 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.2 Fuser unit
3.2.3 Cover-Rear-Blind
(1) Open the front cover and the top cover. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(1) Remove the two screws (silver) .
(2) Remove the fuser unit .
(2) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-5 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.4 Cover-Side-L
3.2.5 Cover-Side-R
(1) Remove the ID unit. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(1) Remove the ID unit. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(2) Remove the fuser unit. (Refer to 3.2.2)
(2) Remove the fuser unit. (Refer to 3.2.2)
(3) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(3) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(4) Remove the four screws (silver) .
(4) Remove the five screws (silver) .
(5) Disengage the six claws, and remove the Cover-Side-L .
(5) Disengage the five claws, and remove the Cover-Side-R .
Claw
Claw
45487001TH Rev.1
Claw
Claw
3-6 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(4) Disconnect all cables from PU/CU-Board .
3.2.6 PU/CU-Board
(5) Remove the four screws (silver) and the screw (silver) , and remove the
PU/CU-Board .
3.2.6.1 PU/CU-Board
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the eight screws (silver) , and remove the Plate-Shield .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-7 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.6.2 How to remove Battery (PU/CU-Board)
(2) How to remove the battery.
Insert finger, a needle or a rod in the gap between the battery and the its holder.
(1) The position of the battery is shown in the below picture.
PU/CU Board
C260
OSC10
F1A
32V
C211
2
1
LAN2
IC35
12
L13
L11
L12
L14
C262
C263
C219
C192
C124
1
4
2
3
RM24
RM17
1
A
144
C49
IC13
48
F2A
32V
USB3
C65
25
48
25
Q17
Q18
45075699
Q16
F2A
32V
1
27
28
10
Q8
F1A
32V
R62
C277
HVOLT
IL
F2A
32V
F5
R70
1
15
DUPSNS
C19
F1A
32V
F1
12
10
R73
R74
R71
R72
F2A
32V
R75
F2A
32V
4 4
32
C283
12
F4A
32V
Raise the battery up so that it is put on the battery stopper, and remove it.
C64
12
Battery
22
21
C42
R87
1 2
17
C62
C56
3
143
C61
C57
1
24
FLCS
RM13
24
IC17
38
RM14
F2A
32V
21
F1A
32V
39
R170
R165
DIMM
F2.5A
32V
BF7
42
AP
IC24
451020
R90
1
A
9
10
R202
C266
C270
C269
R260
C271
C274
C272
C214
C226
D18 D19 D20
RM26
RM30
9
A
R
10
RM27
R247
R245
R241
R238
RM28
C146
C147
C141
R237
Battery Stopper
Board-99M
RM22
38
40
1
37
39
R246
R244
IC22
C224
C233
20
20
R253
R270
R486
1
BF27
C305
C308
C310
RM31
12
34
34
C159
IC25
LAN
AP
R273
C225
AA
C311
C309
C306
BF26
C156
C172
C215
R457
C267
1
3
C275
C278
C285
C279
C288
C273
C286
C287
C276
C209
C210
9
8
R404
F13
16
R271
R272
21
17
32
Rod
CP15
WLPOW
24
R89
BF13
BF14
IC28
C265
F17
F2A
32V
F1A
32V
25
28
R464
R487
HEAD0
STKL
1
R453
C115
R484
BAT1
TAGZA3
USB1
Battery
10
11
HEAT
RSNS
99M
C4
C3
Battery Stopper
Battery
45487001TH Rev.1
3-8 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.7 Power supply unit
Warning
3.2.8 DC motor (hop) / DC motor (ID)
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
Risk of Electric Shock
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
There is a risk of electric shock during replacement of the low voltage power
supply.
(3) Remove the Plate-Shield. (Refer to 3.2.6)
Use insulating gloves or avoid direct contact with any conducting part of the
power supply, and caution should be exercised during replacement.
(5) Remove the three screws(sliver) , remove the DC motor (hop) .
The capacitor may take one minute to complete discharge after the AC cable
is unplugged. Also, there is a possibility that the capacitor doesnt discharge
because of a breakage of the PCB, etc., so remember the possibility of
electric shock to avoid electric shock.
(4) Disconnect the cable from the DC motor (hop) .
(6) Disconnect the cable from the DC motor (ID) .
(7) Remove the three screws(sliver) , remove the DC motor (ID) .
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the Plate-Shield. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Disconnect all cables from power supply unit .
(5) Remove the three screws (silver) and the screw (black) .
(6) Remove the power supply unit and the Sheet-Insulation-LV .
(7) Remove the screw (silver) , the two screws (silver,8mm) and the screw
(silver,M4,8mm) , and remove the AC inlet .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-9 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.9 Motor FAN (PSU)
3.2.10 Motor FAN (ID) / Micro switch
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the Plate-Shield. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(3) Remove the PU/CU-Board. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Disconnect the cable of the USB connector from the PU/CU-Board.
(4) Remove the calbes of the Motor FAN (ID) , the microswitch , the toner
sensor and the TAG contact from the Guide-ID-FAN .
(5) Remove the screw (black) , and remove the USB connector .
(6) Disconnect the cable of Motor FAN (PSU) from the PU/CU-Board.
(7) Remove the two screws (silver) , and remove the Guide-Power-FAN .
(8) Disengage the two claws and remove the Motor FAN (PSU) .
Note! Be careful to install the Motor-FAN (PSU) in the proper direction.
(5) Remove the two screws (black) , and remove the Guide-ID-FAN and the
Sheet-Guide-FAN .
(6) Remove the Motor FAN (ID) .
(7) Disengage the two claws, and remove the micro switch .
Note! Be careful to install the Motor-FAN (ID) in the proper direction.
Claw
Claw
45487001TH Rev.1
3-10 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.11 HV-Board / Motor-FAN
3.2.12 LED Assy
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(1) Remove the ID unit. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-L. (Refer to 3.2.4)
(2) While pushing the LED Assy in the direction of the arrow (a), unhook the part
A by pulling it in the direction of the arrow (b).
(3) Remove the three screws (silver) and the two screws (black) , disengage
the claw, and remove HV-Board . Be careful not to lose the Spring-Contact .
(3) Remove the LED Assy , and disconnect the FFC cable from it.
(4) Disconnect all cables from the HV-Board .
(5) Remove the two screws (silver/28mm) , and remove the Motor-FAN .
Note! 1. Be careful to install the Motor-FAN in the proper direction.
A
b
Claw
45487001TH Rev.1
3-11 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(7) Remove the retainer-4 , and remove the Shaft-Link-Head and the two
Bearing-Metal .
3.2.13 Plate-Assy-Duct
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the Plate-Shield. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Disconnect the FFC cable of the LED head.
(5) Remove the screw (silver) , and remove the Cover-Head .
(6) Remove the three screws (silver) , and remove the Plate-Cable-Guide and
the FFC cable .
(8) Remove the two screws (silver) , and remove the Plate-Assy-Duct .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-12 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.14 Frame-Assy-OP-Panel
3.2.15 LCD panel
(1) Open the front cover. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(1) Separate the Frame-Assy-OP-Panel. (Refer to 3.2.14)
(2) Remove two screws (black) .
(2) Remove the five screws (black) , and remove the board .
(3) Disengage the three claws at the disenge points by a mini minus screwdriver,
and remove the Frame-Assy-OP-Panel .
(3) Disconnect all cables from board .
(4) Disconnect all cables from the Frame-Assy-OP-Panel .
(4) Remove the two screws (black) , and remove the LCD panel .
Disengage point
Claw
45487001TH Rev.1
3-13 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.16 Cover-Assy-Front
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the PU/CU-Board. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Remove the power supply unit. (Refer to 3.2.7)
(5) Remove the screw (silver) , and remove the FG cable of the Cover-Assy-Front
.
(6) Remove the two screws (black) .
(7) Remove the six screws (silver/8mm) , and remove the Cover-Assy-Front .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-14 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.17 Feeder-Assy-Regist / Clutch
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(10) Remove the two screws (silver/8mm) , and remove the Plate-Front .
(11) Remove the five screws (silver) and the two screws (silver) , and remove
the Feeder-Assy-Regist .
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-L and the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.4 / 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the USB connector. (Refer to 3.2.9)
(4) Remove the power supply unit. (Refer to 3.2.7)
(5) Remove the DC motor (hop). (Refer to 3.2.8)
(6) Disconnect all cables of the Feeder-Assy-Regist from the PU/CU-Board.
(7) Remove the screw (black) , and disengage the Stay-Arm-Front from the
Plate-Assy-Side(L).
(8) Remove the two screws (silver) , and remove the Cover-Front-Side-R .
(9) Remove the two screws (silver) , and remove the Cover-Front-Side-L .
Stay-Arm-Front
45487001TH Rev.1
3-15 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(12) Disconnect the cable of the clutch from the PU/CU-Board.
3.2.18 TR-Assy-Front
(13) Remove the e-ring , and remove the clutch .
(1) Remove the transfer roller. (Refer to 3.2.1)
(2) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(3) Remove the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(4) Remove the power supply unit. (Refer to 3.2.7)
(5) Disconnect all cable of TR-Assy-Front from the PU/CU-Board.
(6) Remove the three screws (silver) , and remove the TR-Assy-Front .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-16 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.19 TR-Assy-Rear
3.2.20 Cover-Assy-Stacker
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-L and the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.4 / 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the Plate-Assy-Duct. (Refer to the 3.2.13)
(4) Remove the two screws (silver) , and remove the TR-Assy-Rear .
(3) Remove the Plate-Shield. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Remove the screw (silver) , and remove the Cover-Damper .
(5) Disconnect the cable of Cover-Assy-Stacker from the PU/CU-Board.
(6) Remove the screw (silver) , and remove the FG cable of the Cover-AssyStacker .
(7) Remove the retainer-4 , and remove the Gear-Reduction .
(8) Remove the Cover-Assy-Stacker .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-17 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6) Open the rear cover, and remove the two screws (silver) .
3.2.21 Eject-Assy
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the Cover-Side-L and the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.4 / 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the PU/CU-Board. (Refer to 3.2.6)
(4) Remove the Cover-Assy-Stacker. (Refer to 3.2.20)
(5) Remove the five screws (silver) , and remove the Plate-Centro .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-18 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(7) Remove the cable of the Motor FAN from the Eject-Assy .
(8) Close the rear cover, and remove the Eject-Assy .
(9) Remove the two screws (silver/28mm) , and remove the Motro FAN .
Note! Be careful to install the Motor-FAN in the proper direction.
45487001TH Rev.1
3-19 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.22 DC motor (fuser)
(1) Remove the Cover-Rear-Blind. (Refer to 3.2.3)
(2) Remove the CoverSide-R. (Refer to 3.2.5)
(3) Remove the power supply unit. (Refer to 3.2.7)
(4) Remove the Cover-Assy-Stacker. (Refer to 3.2.20)
(5) Remove the Eject-Assy. (Refer to 3.2.21)
(6) Disconnect the cable from the DC motor (fuser) .
(7) Remove the three screws (silver) , and remove the DC motor (fuser) .
(8) Separate the DC motor (fuser) and the Plate-Motor-FU .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-20 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.23Paper feed rollers
(3) Open the cover while pushing the two tabs (a and b) inward.
(1) Remove the cassette.
a
b
(4) Disengage the two tabs by pushing the both ends of the Frame-Assy-Retard
in the direction of the arrow.
(2) Remove the two paper feed rollers (without gear) and (with gear) while
pushin each tab outward.
Tab
Tab
Tab
Tab
45487001TH Rev.1
3-21 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3. Component replacement
(3) Remove the Frame-Assy-Retard and the spring .
Note! After setting the two paper feed rollers and , check that they do not
come off.
45487001TH Rev.1
3-22 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.24Paper feed rollers (MP tray)
(3) Open the paper set cover.
(1) Open the MP tray forward by inserting your fingers into the front reccesses.
MP tray
Paper set cover
(2) Release the tab of the paper feed roller cover by pressing the right arm inward
while lifting up the MP tray lightly, and release the tab on the left side in the
same manner.
(4) Remove the MPT paper feed roller (with gear) while pushing the tab outward.
Tab
Tab
45487001TH Rev.1
3-23 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Remove the MPT paper feed roller (without gear) while pushing the tab
outward.
Tab
(6) Open the retard roller cover while pushing the center part of the MP tray, and
remove the retard roller .
Retard roller cover
Note! After setting the two paper feed rollers and , check that they do not
come off.
45487001TH Rev.1
3-24 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(2) Disconnect the LAN-Cable and the USB-Cable .
3.2.25W-LAN Board (for Wireless model only)
(3) Remove the Cover and W-LAN Board .
(4) Remove the W-LAN Board from Cover .
(1) Remove the Plate-Sheild.(Refer to 3.2.6)
45487001TH Rev.1
[Memo] Refer to remove the LAN-Cable
1. A wire should be put through to between the stopper of the LAN-Cables Connector and
the Board 99M.
(For example, the wire is the banding band, the aging (not useable) flat cabel or etc.)
2. Both ends of the wire should be pull to the right side of the Mainbody.
3. Check that the stopper released, and pull the LAN-Cable from the LAN Interface
Connector on the Board 99M.
LAN Cable
Wire
3-25 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.2.26Centro Board (for Centro model only)
(1) Remove the five screws (silver) , and remove the Plate-Centro .(Refer to
3.2.21)
(2) Remove the two screws (silver) , and disconnect the FFC Cable and
remove the Centro Board .
45487001TH Rev.1
3-26 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3.3 Portions Lubricated
Portions lubricated are shown in this section. The other portions must not be lubricated.
Lubrication is not required during assembly or disassembly, except that the lubricant
specified must be applied to portions from which lubricant was wiped.
Lubrication work
(1) Lubricant names and their abbreviations
EM-30LP: Molykote EM-30LP
HP-300: Molykote HP-300
EM-D110:
Molykote EM-D110
HANARL: HANARL SF-133
Tetra:
Tetra C-9310 or C-5005
(2) Standard of amount of grease
Class
Amount of grease
(cc)
0.0005
0.003
0.005
0.01
0.03
0.05
0.1
W(mm)
1.24
2.25
2.67
3.37
4.86
5.76
7.26
Sample
45487001TH Rev.1
3-27 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Plate-Assy-Side-R
Plate-Assy-Base
EM-30LP Class A
Apply a normal amount of
MOLYKOTE (EM-30LP) to the
hatched areas. (Spring)
Plate-Assy-Side-R
Spring-Dup-L
Spring-Dup-R
EM-30LP Class A
Apply a normal amount of
MOLYKOTE (EM-30LP) to the
hatched areas of Spring-ID-R.
EM-30LP Class B
Apply a normal amount of MOLYKOTE
(EM-30LP) to the sliding surface with
Drum Shaft (hatched areas).
45487001TH Rev.1
3-28 /
3. Component replacement
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Cassette-Assy
EM-30LP Class B
Apply a normal amount of
MOLYKOTE (EM-30LP) to the
sliding areas by one point.
Cassette-Assy
Plate-Assy-Receive
45487001TH Rev.1
EM-30LP Class B
Apply a normal amount of
MOLYKOTE (EM-30LP) to the
hatched areas. (Sliding areas)
3-29 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4. Maintenance menus
The Printer can be adjusted by using Maintenance Utility, or button operation on its operator panel.
On the panel, maintenance menus are provided in addition to general menus. Select the menu intended for
each adjustment purpose.
4.1 System maintenance menu (For maintenance personnel).........4-2
4.2 Maintenance Utility.....................................................................4-3
4.3 User maintenance menu functions.............................................4-5
4.4 Setup after part replacement....................................................4-36
4.5 Manual density adjustment setting...........................................4-38
4.6 Boot Menu List.........................................................................4-39
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.1 System maintenance menu (For maintenance personnel)
This menu is activated when the back and <ENTER> and <ON LINE> buttons are held
down for 5 seconds while the printer is ready to print.
The menu is displayed in English irrespective of the destination of the product.
Note! Since this menu is changed depending on the destination or for other reason,
it is not disclosed to the end users.
Category
Item (1st Line)
Value
(2nd Line)
DF
Engine Diag Mode
Enters self-diagnosis mode of the engine.
Change
Password
Displays menus to change a password.
New
Password
******
******
Sets a new password to enter "System
Maintenance" menu
From 6 to 12 digits of number or Roman
character can be enter.
Verify
Password
******
******
Makes User input the new password to enter
"System Maintenance" menu which is set by
"New Password" for confirmation.
From 6 to 12 digits of number or Roman
character can be enter.
Table 4-1 Maintenance menu display table
Category
System
Maintenance
Item (1st Line)
Value
(2nd Line)
DF
Functions
Enter Password
******
******
Save Syslog
Execute
Save network communication log(syslog)
to flash rom.
Print Syslog
Execute
Print the saved network communication
log(syslog).
Engine Diag Mode
Execute
It will be ONLINE by pressing ENTER key
which issues the command from CU to PU.
Check for the operation while changing the
factories supplies during keeping the power
ON. A new fuse will not cut and the countoperation will not be included in the old
value).
The check mode will finish and invalid if
turing the power ON.
45487001TH Rev.1
000 Enters a password to enter the system
000 maintenance menu. The default is 000000.
From 6 to 12 digits of number or Roman
character can be enter
Functions
4-2 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.2 Maintenance Utility
The adjustments described in table 4-2 should be made by using Maintenance Utility. Details
on the utility are as follows:
Item
Adjustment
(1) Maintenance Utility operation manuals:
3 Factory/
Shipping
Mode
42678801FU01 Version 30.6 or higher (Japanese)
42678801FU02 Version 30.6 or higher (English)
(2) Maintenance Utility program:
Applicable operating
system
Win2000/XP/Vista/7
(Japanese/English)
File name
Part number
MuWin.zip
42678801FW01 Version 1.42.0 or higher
Table 4-2 Maintenance Utility Adjustment Items
Item
Adjustment
Operation from
Section in
operator panel
Maintenance
(section in this
Utility Operation
maintenance manual)
manual
1 Board
Replacement
Copies the information from the
EEPROM on the PU/CU board, and
copies the EEPROM setting value on
PU/CU board.
Purpose: To copy the information
stored on the EEPROM on the PU/CU
board when the PU/CU board needs
to be replaced with another one due to
maintenance.
Section
2.4.1.1.9
2 Serial
Number
Information
Setting
Rewrites the serial number recorded
on the PU, and Selects the printer
serial number recorded on the CU,
output mode, and rewrites the device
serial number.
Purpose: To configure a maintenance
replacement board to which the
information on the PU/CU board
cannot be copied (due to an interface
error).
Section
2.4.1.1.10.3
45487001TH Rev.1
Unavailable
Switches between Factory and
Shipping modes.
Purpose: To configure a maintenance
replacement PU/CU board to which the
information on the EEPROM on the PU/
CU board cannot be copied (due to an
interface error). The maintenance board
is set to the Factory mode usually by
default and, by using this function, must
be set to the Shipping mode.
Operation from
Section in
operator panel
Maintenance
(section in this
Utility Operation
maintenance manual)
manual
Section
2.4.1.1.10.4
Section 6.3.2.10
Checks serial number information and
4 Board
the Factory/Shipping mode.
items
setting
information
Section
2.4.1.1.7
Unavailable
5 Network
Software
Updates the NIC software.
Section
2.4.2.2.17
Unavailable
6 Mac
address
setting
Sets the Mac address
Section
2.4.2.2.5
Unavailable
7 Counter
maintenance
function
Copies the counter value of each
consumable:
Drum counter
Fuser counter
Belt counter
Toner counter
Purpose: To copy the counter value of
each consumable in the printer to use
in another printer.
Section
2.4.1.2.1
Unavailable
Section
2.4.1.2.9
Section 6.4.3
Section
2.4.2.2.14
Unavailable
Unavailable
8 Brand/PnP Sets or checks the (CU) destination,
information device identification and USB
identification.
9 Network
Log Save
function
Stores Network log files.
4-3 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Adjustment
10 Send to file Transmits a specified file.
11 PU Log
File Save
function
Stores PU log flies.
Checks the current consumable
12 Counter/
counter values.
Toner
information
13 Menu
setting
values
Displays the menu settings set on the
printer (CU).
14 Printer
Checks the Mac address and each
information firmware version.
Operation from
Section in
operator panel
Maintenance
(section in this
Utility Operation
maintenance manual)
manual
Section
2.4.1.2.13
Unavailable
Section
2.4.2.2.16
Unavailable
Section
2.4.1.3.1
Section 6.3.2.8
Section
2.4.1.3.2
Print a configuration
report (Menu Map)
(refer to Users
Manual).
Section
2.4.1.3.3
Print a configuration
report (Menu Map)
(refer to Users
Manual).
15 Memory
Checks the information on the CPU
information and memory installed on the printer
(CU).
Section
2.4.1.3.4
Print a configuration
report (Menu Map)
(refer to Users
Manual).
16 Test print
Executes the local print function and
sends a specified file.
Purpose: To check the printer on
a stand-alone basis and send a
download file.
Section
2.4.1.4.1
Perform local printing
(refer to System
Specification
17 Save local
print data
Stores files of local print data
Section
2.4.1.4.2
Unavailable
18 Switch
scan test
Executes the switch scan test.
Purpose: To check each sensor for
proper operation.
Section
2.4.1.5.1
Section 6.3.2.3
19 Motor and
Clutch
Tests
Executes the motor clutch test.
Purpose: To check each item, such as
a motor or clutch, for proper operation.
Section
2.4.1.5.2
Section 6.3.2.4
Section
2.4.1.5.3
Section 6.3.2.6
Executes the color registration
20 Color
registration adjustment test.
adjustment
function
45487001TH Rev.1
Item
Adjustment
Executes the density adjustment test.
21 Density
adjustment
test
Operation from
Section in
operator panel
Maintenance
(section in this
Utility Operation
maintenance manual)
manual
Section
2.4.1.5.4
Section 6.3.2.7
Never use
this option.
Section 6.3.2.7
Section
2.4.1.5.6
Section 6.3.2.8
Switches between the Factory and
24 Local
Shipping modes and checks the status
Parameof the fuse.
ters
Setting/
Information
Section
2.4.1.5.7
Section 6.3.2.10
Makes an engine parameter setting.
25 Engine
Parameters Setting
Section
2.4.1.5.8
Section 6.3.2.11
Makes a print media transfer parameter
26 Translate
setting.
Parameters Setting
Section
2.4.1.5.9
Section 6.3.2.11
Stores self-diagnosis log files of printer
paper running system.
Section
2.4.1.5.10
Unavailable
22 Automatic Sets the auto density setting control
parameter.
Density
Adjustment
Control
Parameters Setting
(DENSITY
ADJUST
PAR-SET)
23 Counter
27 PU
diagnosis
log save
function
Checks the consumable, continuous
consumable and waste toner counter
values.
Note! Do not operate or set options marked with Never use this option, or a
malfunction is potentially caused.
4-4 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3 User maintenance menu functions
4.3.1 Maintenance menu (for end-users)
Item
Some general menu categories on the operator panel of the printer serve as maintenance
menus (but are not system maintenance menus).
Menus System Auto Continue
Adjust
Settings
On
Off
Sets whether a printer is automatically
recovered or not when memory overflow/
tray request occurs.
(Wait time for recovery: 15 sec)
Manual Timeout
Off
30 seconds
60 seconds
Sets time to wait for paper to be fed in
manual feed.
If paper is not fed within this period of
time, the job is canceled.
Timeout Injob
Off
5 seconds
10 seconds
20 seconds
30 seconds
40 seconds
50 seconds
60 seconds
90 seconds
120 seconds
150 seconds
180 seconds
210 seconds
240 seconds
270 seconds
300 seconds
Sets time between stopping reception of
job data and performing force printing.
Does not perform printing and cancels that
job instead in the case of PS.
Timeout Local
0 seconds
5 seconds
~
40 seconds
~
290 seconds
295 seconds
300 seconds
Time of open of each port after end of
job(The network is excluded. )
Time of the port open indicates the time
that open the current port which receiving
the current job and so other port be able
to receive data.
It increase /decreases in the step of 5
The options available in the menus are as follows:
Default setting in shade area
Item
Settings
Functions
1 minute
2 minutes
3 minutes
4 minutes
5 minutes
10 minutes
15 minutes
30 minutes
60 minutes
Sets time to wait for moving to Power Save
mode.
Moves to Power Save mode even during
an error.
1 minute
2 minutes
3 minutes
4 minutes
5 minutes
10 minutes
15 minutes
30 minutes
60 minutes
Sets the time to switch from Power Save
mode to Sleep mode.
The start point is the moment when the
printer goes into PowerSave.
The printer will not enter sleep mode at
the following conditions.
Parallel is enabled.
Network is working on 1000Base-T Full/
Half speed.
Error occurs.
Auto Power Off Time
1 hour
2 hours
3 hours
4 hours
8 hours
12 hours
18 hours
24 hours
Set the time to switch from Idle state to Off
mode.
Clearable Warning
Online
Job
Sets display deletion timing of clearable
warnings.
PS: JOB only
Menus System Power Save Time
Adjust
Sleep Time
45487001TH Rev.1
Functions
4-5 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Menus System Timeout Network
Adjust
Low Toner
Settings
Functions
0 seconds
5 seconds
~
90 seconds
~
290 seconds
295 seconds
300 seconds
Time of open of Network port after end of
job
Time of the port open indicates the time
that open the current port which receiving
the current job and so other port be able
to receive data.
It increase /decreases in the step of 5
[Conditions for display]
A NIC FW is installed.
Continue
Stop
Sets printer operation when Toner Low is
detected.
In CONTINUE, the printer can continue
printing while remaining ON-LINE.
In STOP, it becomes OFF-LINE.
[Conditions for display]
The consumable is SEPARATION mode or
COMBINATION mode will be decided by
a PU Factory PJL command. This menu
item is only displayed in the SEPARATION
mode.
Jam Recovery
On
Off
Sets whether JAM RECOVERY printing is
performed or not when Jam occurs.
When it is set to OFF, a job that includes
the page to which Jam has occurred will
be cancelled.
Error Report
On
Off
Sets whether an error report is printed or
not when an internal error occurs.
Valid only for PS and PCL XL.
Hex Dump
Execute
Prints out data received from the host
PC in the hexadecimal Dump. Turning off
the power supply switch restores Normal
Mode from HEX Dump Mode.
45487001TH Rev.1
Item
Menus Print
Adjust
Settings
MPtray, X
Print
Position Tray1, Adjust
Adjust
Tray2,
Tray3,
Tray4
Y
Adjust
Functions
0.00 mm
+0.25 mm to
+2.00 mm
-2.00 mm to
-0.25 mm
Adjusts the position of a whole print image
in the direction that is perpendicular to the
direction paper runs, that is horizontally (at
0.25 mm pitch).
0.00 mm
+0.25 mm to
+2.00 mm
-2.00 mm to
-0.25 mm
Adjust the position of a whole print image
in the direction paper runs, that is vertically
(at 0.25mm pitch).
Duplex 0.00 mm
print X +0.25 mm to
Adjust +2.00 mm
-2.00 mm to
-0.25 mm
At the time of back page printing of
Duplex, adjusts the position of the
whole print image in the direction that is
perpendicular to the direction paper runs,
that is horizontally (at 0.25mm pitch).
Duplex 0.00 mm
print Y +0.25 mm to
Adjust +2.00 mm
-2.00 mm to
-0.25 mm
At the time of back page printing of
Duplex, adjusts the position of a whole
print image in the direction paper runs,
that is vertically (at 0.25mm pitch).
Paper Black Setting
0
+1
+2
+3
-3
-2
-1
Use it for fine adjustment of the significant
dust attachment on the surface and when
thin spot has the sighificant impact on the
standard/BLACK printing or other cases
occur. The decrement is necessary if the
scattered or snow-white like printing is the
result in the high density-printing area. The
increment is necessary if the thin printing
is found.
Trans. Black Setting
0
+1
+2
+3
-3
-2
-1
Use it for fine adjustment of the significant
dust attachment on the surface and when
thin spot has the significant impact on
OHP/BLACK printing. The decrement
is necessary if the scattered or snowwhite like printing is the result in the high
density-printing area. The increment is
necessary if the thin printing is found.
4-6 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Menus Print
Adjust
Settings
0
+1
+2
-2
-1
Sets print darkness.
SMR Setting
0
+1
+2
+3
-3
-2
-1
To correct variations in print results
caused by temperature/humility conditions
and difference in print density/frequency.
Change the setting when print quality is
uneven.
0
+1
+2
+3
-3
-2
-1
To correct variations in print results
caused by temperature/humility conditions
and difference in print density/frequency.
Change the setting when background is
dark.
On
Off
Sets whether to rotate the drum in
idle prior to printing in order to reduce
horizontal white lines. Be warned that
this will shorten the ID life as much as this
rotation.
BG Setting
Drum Cleaning
Admin Setup
Functions
Darkness
On
Off
Sets On or Off for the curl reduction mode.
Quiet Mode
On
Off
Sets Off/On of the quiet printing mode.
Enter Password
************
Enters a password to enter Admin Setup
menu.
The default value is "aaaaaa."
From 6 to 12 digits of numbers or Roman
character to input.
45487001TH Rev.1
TCP/IP
Enable
Disable
Settings
Network IP Version
setup
NetBIOS
over TCP
High Humid Mode
Network
setup
Item
Admin Setup
Sets Enable/Disable of TCP/IP Protocol.
Functions
IP v4
IP v4+v6
IP v6
Set up the IP version.
There is only IPv4 and IPv4+v6 as normal
value.
From this stage, If IPv6 only is set from
UI, for example Telnet, "IPv6" appears as
the value of IP VERSION on the operation
panel. "IPv6" will disapears from the value
if "IP v4","IP v4+v6" is selected.
[Conditions for display]
"TCP/IP"should be ENABLE
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of NetBIOS over TCP
Protocol.
[Condition for display]
"Enable" is selected for "TCP/IP" and also
"IP Version" is not IP v6.
IP Address Auto
Set
Manual
Sets the IP address setting method.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
IPv4
Address
xxx.xxx.xxx.
xxx
Sets the IP address.
[Condition for display]
"Enable" is selected for "TCP/IP" and also
"IP Version" is not IP v6.
Subnet
Mask
xxx.xxx.xxx.
xxx
Sets the subnet mask.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
Gateway
Address
xxx.xxx.xxx.
xxx
Sets the Gateway (default router) address.
0.0.0.0 means that there is no router.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
Web
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Web.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
Telnet
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Telnet.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
4-7 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
Settings
Network FTP
setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Functions
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of FTP.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
IPSec
Enable
Disable
Displayed only when Enable is selected
for TCP/IP and allows a change only to
Disable.
(It is because many settings besides this
setting are required to enable IPSec.
Therefore, it is allowed to be cleared only
for restoration.)
SNMP
Enable
Disable
Sets SNMP of FTP.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP".
Network
Scale
Normal
Small
When Normal is selected, it can work
effectively even when it is connected to
HUB that has a spanning tree feature.
However, printer start up time gets longer
when computers are connected with two
or three small LANs.
When Small is selected, computers can
cover from two or three small LANs to a
large LAN, but it may not work effectively
when it is connected to HUB with a
spanning tree feature.
Gigabit
Network
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Gigabit network.
When this is Enabled, and the network
is working on 1000Base-T Full/Half, the
printer will not enter sleep mode.
Hub Link
Setting
Auto Negotiate Sets a method to link with HUB.
100Base-TX
Full
100Base-TX
Half
10Base-T Full
10Base-T Half
Item
Admin Setup
Network
setup
Parallel
Setup
Settings
Functions
TCP ACK
Type1
Type2
Sets a type of TCP Acknowledgment.
When Type1 is set, the printer replies to
every packet.
When Type2 is set, the printer replies to
plural packets in a mass.
When printing comes to take time by the
setting of the hub, choosing Type2 may
improve the matter.
Usually, setting Type1 hasn't any problem.
[Conditions for display]
"Enable" is selected in "TCP/IP."
Factory
Defaults?
Execute
Specifies whether to initialize the network
menu or not.
Parallel
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Centro I/F.
When this is Enabled, the printer will not
enter sleep mode.
BiDirection
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of bi-directional
Centro.
ECP
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of ECP mode.
Ack Width
Narrow
Medium
Wide
Sets ACK width for compatible reception.
NARROW = 0.5s
MEDIUM = 1.0s
WIDE = 3.0s
Ack/Busy
Timing
Ack in Busy
Sets the order to output the BUSY
Ack while Busy signal and the ACK signal for compatible
reception.
ACK IN BUSY: BUSY=LOW-> The end of
ACK pulse
ACK WHILE BUSY: BUSY=LOW -> The
center of ACK pulse
I-Prime
3 microseconds
50 microseconds
Disable
Sets time to enable/disable the I-PRIME
signal.
3 MICRO SEC: Enabled with the 3s nInit
signal.
50 MICRO SEC: Enabled with the 50s
nInit signal.
When I-Prime is received when enabled,
only Centro driver is initialized.
4-8 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
Parallel
Setup
USB
Setup
Settings
Offline
Receive
Enable
Disable
Functions
Sets Enable/Disable of a function that
keeps receive-possible state without
changing an I/F signal even though an
alarm occurs. When this is set to Enable,
I/F keeps receive-possible state even
while the printer is moving to Off-line
because you press operating panel switch.
I/F sends the BUSY signal only when
the reception buffer is full or service call
occurs.
USB
Enable
Disable
Sets able/disable of USB I/F.
Speed
Enable
Disable
Sets of the max. USB I/F transfer speed.
Soft Reset Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Soft Reset
command.
Serial
Number
Specifies Enable/Disable of a USB serial
number. A USB serial number is used to
identify a USB device to which a PC is
connected.
Enable
Disable
Offline
Receive
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of a function that
keeps receive-possible state without
changing I/F signal even though an alarm
occurs. When this is set to Enable, I/F
keeps receive-possible state even while
the printer is moving to Off-line because
you press operating panel switch. I/F
sends the BUSY signal only when the
reception buffer is full or service call
occurs.
USB
Memory
Interface
Enable
Disable
Sets able/disable of USB memory I/F.
Admin Appli
See "Embedded JavaVM User's Guide" (an
applicable specification) for details on Java
Application.
JavaVM Setup
See "Embedded JavaVM User's Guide" (an
applicable specification) for details on Java
Application.
45487001TH Rev.1
Item
Admin Setup
Print
Setup
Settings
Functions
Personality
Auto
PCL
XPS
IBM PPR
EPSON FX
PostScript
Selects a printer language.
Copies
1
~
999
Sets the number of copies. This setting is
disabled for Local Print except for Demo
Page
Duplex
On
Off
Specifies Duplex Print.
Binding
Long Edge
Short Edge
Specifies Binding in Duplex Printing.
[Conditions for display]
"On" is selected in "Duplex" menu above.
Media
Check
Enable
Disable
Sets whether the printer checks the
matching of paper size of the print data
and that of the tray. Only standard sizes
are subject to be checked.
A4/Letter
Override
No
Yes
(1)When the paper size of a job has been
set to A4 and A4 has not been set in a
printer, if there is Letter paper in it, this
job will be printed by Letter paper without
paper requesting.
(2)When the paper size of a job has been
set to Letter and Letter has not been set in
a printer, if there is A4 paper in it, this job
will be printed by A4 paper without paper
requesting.
[Conditions for display]
"Off" is selected in "Edge to Edge".
Edge to
Edge
On
Off
The printing area will be extended.
When On is set, print margin will be
changed to 2mm in PCL/PS printing.
When Off is set, print margin will be as
usual setting and specs.
[Conditions for display]
"No" is selected in "A4/Letter Override".
Resolution 600dpi
1200dpi
Sets the resolution.
4-9 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
Print
Setup
Settings
Off
Low
High
Set the toner save level.
Off: Invalidate toner save.
Low: use toner by 75%.
High: use toner by 50%.
Default
Orientation
Portrait
Landscape
Specifies print orientation.
It is invalid for PS. (it is valid only for PCL/
IBMPPR/ EPSONFX)
Form
Length
5lines
~
60lines
~
64lines
~
128lines
Edit Size
45487001TH Rev.1
Item
Functions
Toner
Save
Admin Setup
Print
Setup
Functions
Specifies paper width of Custom paper as
a default value. Sets a paper in a direction
*A perpendicular to paper run direction
Default values listed to the left are for
*L Letter/A4.
76millimeter
~
210millimeter
*A
~
216millimeter
*L
Sets the number of lines that can be
printed on a page. (Only for PCL)Invalid in
*L PS.
Default values listed to the left are for
*A Letter/A4.
In practice, however, they change
according to the size of paper loaded in
the tray.
Cassette Size
A4
A5
A6
B5
B6
Legal14
Legal13.5
Legal13
Letter
Executive
16K(184x260mm)
16K(195x270mm)
16K(197x273mm)
Statement
Custom
Com-9 Envelope
Com-10 Envelope
Monarch
Envelope
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
C6 Envelope
Index Card
Settings
X
3inch
Dimension ~
8.3inch
~
8.5inch
Y
5inch
Dimension ~
11.0inch
Sets the size of an area to draw when the
host PC does not specify the size by the
paper edit size designating command.
(Only for PCL)Invalid in PS.
~
11.7inch
~
52.0inch
Specifies paper length of Custom paper as
a default value. Sets a paper in the same
*L direction to paper run direction.
Default values listed to the left are for
Letter/A4.
*A
127millimeter
~
279millimeter
*L
~
297millimeter
*A
~
1321millimeter
PS
Setup
Network
Protocol
ASCII
RAW
Specifies PS communication protocol
mode of data from NIC.
(In RAW mode, Ctrl-T is invalid.)
[Conditions for display]
A NIC FW is installed.
Parallel
Protocol
ASCII
RAW
Specifies PS communication protocol
mode of data from Centro.
(In RAW mode, Ctrl-T is invalid.)
4-10 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
PS
Setup
Settings
USB
Protocol
ASCII
RAW
PDF Paper Current Tray Size
Size
Size in PDF file
Scaling Size
PCL
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Functions
Specifies PS communication protocol
mode of data from USB.
(In RAW mode, Ctrl-T is invalid.)
Paper size Select of PDF Direct Print
Current Tray Size : It selects the current
tray, and it lets fit paper size of the tray.
Size in PDF file : It refers to the paper size
in a PDF file and does an automatic tray
selection.
Scaling Size : It refers to the paper size
in a PDF file and does an automatic tray
selection. If the paper with the same size
with PDF file, print on it. If ther is not,
request paper on current tray, and scaling
print.
PDF
Scaling
Size
1%
~
99%
Specifies scaling size by percent when
PDF Paper Size is set to Scaling Size.
[Conditions for display]
This menu only is displayed when PDF
Paper Size is set to Scaling Size.
Font
Source
Resident
Downloaded
Specifies the location of PCL default font.
Downloaded: Displayed when soft font
is downloaded to RAM as permanent
designation.
Font
Number
0
S1
Sets the PCL font number.
The valid range of this variable changes
depending on the FONT SOURCE setting
at the time. If the default font is set for
FONT SOURCE, the number starts at
0. If it is not, the number starts at 1. The
maximum value is equal to the number of
fonts installed in FONT SOURCE.
S1 is displayed only when soft font is
downloaded with permanent designation.
Font Pitch
0.44CPI
~
10.00CPI
~
99.99CPI
Width of the PCL default font. The unit
is character/inch (Default font is fixedpitch, scalable font.) The value of pitch
is displayed down to the second decimal
place (in the unit of 0.01 CPI).
Displayed only when the font selected in
Font No. is fixed-spacing, scalable font.
Item
Admin Setup
PCL
Setup
Settings
Functions
Font
Height
4.00 point
~
12.00 point
~
999.75 point
Height of the PCL default font. The value
is displayed down to the second decimal
place (in the unit of 0.25 POINT.)
Displayed only when the font selected in
Font No. is proportional-spacing, scalable
font.
Symbol
Set
PC-8
PC-8 Dan/Nor
PC-8 Grk
PC-8 TK
PC-775
PC-850
PC-851 Grk
PC-852
PC-855
PC-857 TK
PC-858
PC-862 Heb
PC-864 L/A
PC-866
PC-866 Ukr
PC-869
PC-1004
Pi Font
Plska Mazvia
PS Math
PS Text
Roman-8
Roman-9
Roman Ext
Serbo Croat1
Serbo Croat2
Spanish
Ukrainian
VN Int'l
VN Math
VN US
Win 3.0
Win 3.1 Arb
Win 3.1 L/G
Win 3.1 Blt
Win 3.1 Cyr
Win 3.1 Grk
Sets a symbol set of PCL.
Modifies a symbol set to the default
symbol set of the font when the selected
font of FONT No. can not use the selected
symbol set.
4-11 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
PCL
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Settings
Symbol
Set
Win 3.1 Heb
Win 3.1 L1
Win 3.1 L2
Win 3.1 L5
Wingdings
Dingbats MS
Symbol
OCR-A
OCR-B
OCRB Subset2
HP ZIP
USPSFIM
USPSSTP
USPSZIP
Arabic-8
Bulgarian
CWI Hung
DeskTop
German
Greek-437
Greek-437 Cy
Greek-737
Greek-8
Greek-928
Hebrew NC
Hebrew OC
Hebrew-7
Hebrew-8
IBM-437
IBM-850
IBM-860
IBM-863
IBM-865
ISO Dutch
ISO L1
ISO L2
ISO L4
ISO L5
ISO L6
ISO L9
ISO Swedish1
ISO Swedish2
ISO Swedish3
ISO-2 IRV
Item
Functions
Admin Setup
PCL
Setup
Settings
Functions
Symbol
Set
ISO-4 UK
ISO-6 ASC
ISO-10 S/F
ISO-11 Swe
ISO-14 JASC
ISO-15 Ita
ISO-16 Por
ISO-17 Spa
ISO-21 Ger
ISO-25 Fre
ISO-57 Chi
ISO-60 Nor
ISO-61 Nor
ISO-69 Fre
ISO-84 Por
ISO-85 Spa
ISO-Cyr
ISO-Grk
ISO-Hebrew
Kamenicky
Legal
Math-8
MC Text
MS Publish
PC Ext D/N
PC Ext US
PC Set1
PC Set2 D/N
PC Set2 US
A4 Print
Width
78 column
80 column
Sets in PCL the number of characters for
A4 paper Auto LF.
This is for 10-CPI characters when Auto
CR/LF Mode is set to OFF.
This menu is enabled only when A4 paper
is selected in the menu that sets the print
width of A4 paper in portrait orientation.
White
Page Skip
On
Off
Sets whether to eject or not a page
without any data to print (blank page) upon
reception of FF command (OCH) in PCL
Mode. OFF: Ejecting.
4-12 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
PCL
Setup
Settings
Sets performance when CR code is
received in PCL.
CR: Carriage Return
CR+LF: Carriage Return and Line Feed
LF Function
LF
LF+CR
Sets performance when LF code is
received in PCL.
LF: Line Feed
LF+CR: Line Feed and Carriage Return
Normal
1/5 inch
1/6 inch
1/12.5 inch
Sets a non-printable area of paper.
The width of the area along the right and
left sides of paper (left and right of paper
laid out according to paper orientation)
paper outside the printable area
NORMAL: PCL emulation compatible,
approximately 1/4~1/4.3INCH (depending
on paper) is outside the printable area.
The option "1/12.5 inch" only be displayed
when Edge to Edge function was enabled.
On
Off
When the minimum width is specified in
PCL, if you draw a 1-dot line, it sometimes
looks broken.
With PEN WIDTH Adjust set to ON, when
the minimum width is specified, the line
width will be emphasized so as to look
wider than a 1-dot line.
Print Margin
Pen Width
Adjust
Tray
ID#
45487001TH Rev.1
MP
Tray
Item
Functions
CR Function CR
CR+LF
1
~
4
~
59
Sets the # to specify the MPTray for
the paper feed destination command
(ESC&l#H) in PCL5e emulation.
Tray1
1
~
59
Sets the # to specify Tray 1 for the paper
feed destination command (ESC&l#H) in
PCL5e emulation.
Tray2
1
~
5
~
59
Sets the # to specify Tray 2 for the paper
feed destination command (ESC&l#H) in
PCL5e emulation. Displayed only if the
Tray 2 is installed.
Admin Setup
PCL
Setup
XPS
Setup
Settings
Tray
ID#
Functions
Tray3
1
~
20
~
59
Sets the # to specify Tray 3 for the paper
feed destination command (ESC&l#H) in
PCL5e emulation. Displayed only if the
Tray 3 is installed.
Tray4
1
~
21
~
59
Sets the # to specify Tray 4 for the paper
feed destination command (ESC&l#H) in
PCL5e emulation. Displayed only if the
Tray 4 is installed.
DigitalSignature
Print Invalid Sign Sets up the DigitalSignature function.
PrintOnlyValidSign Print Invalid Sign: If a document has been
tampered, the printer prints a normal print
Off
report and a temper error report.
Print Only Valid Sign: If a document has
been tampered, the printer prints only a
tamper error report.
Off: No signatures are verified.
DiscardControl
Auto
Each Page
Off
Sets up the DiscardControl function.
Auto: Frees resources as necessary.
EachPage: Frees resources page by page
according to markups.
Off: Disables the DiscardControl function.
MC Mode
On
Off
Sets up the MarkupComaptibility function.
On: Uses the MarkupComaptibility
function.
Off: Not use the MarkupComaptibility
function.
Unzip Mode
Auto
Speed
Print
Specifies the unzip method for XPS flies.
Auto: Automatically switches modes
depending on files.
Speed: Prioritizes print speed and doesn't
use the partial Unzip function.
Print: Prioritizes print processing and uses
the partial Unzip function.
White Page
Skip
On
Off
Sets whether or not to eject pages that
contain no print data (blank pages) using
XPS.
When Off is selected, blank pages are
ejected, if any.
4-13 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
IBM
PPR
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Settings
Functions
Character
Pitch
10 CPI
12 CPI
17 CPI
20 CPI
Proportional
Specifies character pitch in IBM PPR
emulation.
Font
Condense
12CPI to 20CPI
12CPI to 12CPI
Specifies 12CPI pitch for Condense Mode.
Character
Set
SET-2
SET-1
Sets a character set.
Symbol
Set
IBM-437
IBM-850
IBM-860
IBM-863
IBM-865
PC Set1
PC Ext US
PC Ext D/N
PC Set2 US
PC Set2 D/N
Roman-8
ISO L1
PC-8
PC-8 Dan/Nor
PC-850
Legal
ISO-2 IRV
ISO-4 UK
ISO-6 ASC
ISO-10 S/F
ISO-11 Swe
ISO-14 JASC
ISO-15 Ita
ISO-16 Por
ISO-17 Spa
ISO-21 Ger
ISO-25 Fre
ISO-57 Chi
ISO-60 Nor
ISO-61 Nor
ISO-69 Fre
ISO-84 Por
ISO-85 Spa
Sets a symbol set.
Item
Admin Setup
IBM
PPR
Setup
Settings
Symbol
Set
Functions
German
Spanish
ISO Dutch
Roman Ext
ISO Swedish1
ISO Swedish2
ISO Swedish3
VN Math
VN Int'l
VN US
PS Math
PS Text
Math-8
Pi Font
MS Publish
Win 3.0
DeskTop
Win 3.1 L1
MC Text
PC-852
Win 3.1 L5
Win 3.1 L2
CWI Hung
PC-857 TK
ISO L2
ISO L5
PC-8 TK
Kamenicky
Hebrew NC
Hebrew OC
Plska Mazvia
ISO L6
Win 3.1 Heb
Win 3.1 Cyr
PC-866
Win 3.1 Grk
PC-869
PC-855
Greek-437
Greek-437 Cy
Greek-737
Greek-928
Serbo Croat2
Ukrainian
4-14 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
IBM
PPR
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Settings
Symbol
Set
Item
Functions
Admin Setup
Bulgarian
PC-1004
Win 3.1 Blt
PC-775
Serbo Croat1
PC-858
Roman-9
ISO L9
Greek-8
Win 3.1 L/G
PC-851 Grk
PC-8 Grk
Hebrew-7
ISO-Hebrew
Hebrew-8
PC-862 Heb
ISO-Cyr
ISO-Grk
PC-866 Ukr
ISO L4
IBM
PPR
Setup
EPSON
FX
Setup
Letter O
Style
Enable
Disable
Specifies the style that replaces (9B)
and (9D) with (ou) and (zero)
Zero
Character
Normal
Slashed
Specifies the style of 0(zero).
SLASHED: SLASH ZERO
Line Pitch
6 LPI
8 LPI
Sets line space.
White
Page Skip
On
Off
Sets ejecting or not ejecting a blank sheet.
Available only when simplex is set.
CR
Function
CR
CR+LF
Sets performance when CR code is
received.
LF
Function
LF
LF+CR
Sets performance when LF code is
received.
Line
Length
80 column
136 column
Specifies the number of characters per
line.
Form
Length
11 inch
11.7 inch
12 inch
TOF
Position
0.0inch
0.1inch
~
1.0inch
*L Specifies the length of paper.
*A
Sets the position from the top edge of
paper.
Settings
Functions
Left
Margin
0.0inch
0.1inch
~
1.0inch
Sets the amount to shift the horizontal
print start position to the right.
Fit to
Letter
Enable
Disable
Text
Height
Same
Diff
Sets height of a character.
SAME: Regardless of CPI, same height
DIFF: According to CPI, character heights
vary.[Existing model compatible]
Character
Pitch
10 CPI
12 CPI
17 CPI
20 CPI
Proportional
Specifies character pitch.
Character
Set
SET-2
SET-1
Specifies a character set.
Symbol
Set
IBM-437
IBM-850
IBM-860
IBM-863
IBM-865
PC Set1
PC Ext US
PC Ext D/N
PC Set2 US
PC Set2 D/N
Roman-8
ISO L1
PC-8
PC-8 Dan/Nor
PC-850
Legal
ISO-2 IRV
ISO-4 UK
ISO-6 ASC
ISO-10 S/F
ISO-11 Swe
ISO-14 JASC
ISO-15 Ita
ISO-16 Por
Specifies a symbol set.
*L Sets the printing mode that can fit print
*A data, equivalent to 11 inches (66 lines), in
the LETTER-size printable area.
4-15 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
EPSON
FX
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Settings
Symbol
Set
ISO-17 Spa
ISO-21 Ger
ISO-25 Fre
ISO-57 Chi
ISO-60 Nor
ISO-61 Nor
ISO-69 Fre
ISO-84 Por
ISO-85 Spa
German
Spanish
ISO Dutch
Roman Ext
ISO Swedish1
ISO Swedish2
ISO Swedish3
VN Math
VN Int'l
VN US
PS Math
PS Text
Math-8
Pi Font
MS Publish
Win 3.0
DeskTop
Win 3.1 L1
MC Text
PC-852
Win 3.1 L5
Win 3.1 L2
CWI Hung
PC-857 TK
ISO L2
ISO L5
PC-8 TK
Kamenicky
Hebrew NC
Hebrew OC
Plska Mazvia
ISO L6
Win 3.1 Heb
Win 3.1 Cyr
PC-866
Item
Functions
Admin Setup
EPSON
FX
Setup
Settings
Functions
Symbol
Set
Win 3.1 Grk
PC-869
PC-855
Greek-437
Greek-437 Cy
Greek-737
Greek-928
Serbo Croat2
Ukrainian
Bulgarian
PC-1004
Win 3.1 Blt
PC-775
Serbo Croat1
PC-858
Roman-9
ISO L9
Greek-8
Win 3.1 L/G
PC-851 Grk
PC-8 Grk
Hebrew-7
ISO-Hebrew
Hebrew-8
PC-862 Heb
ISO-Cyr
ISO-Grk
PC-866 Ukr
ISO L4
Letter O
Style
Enable
Disable
Specifies the style that replaces (9B)
and (9D) with (ou) and (zero)
Zero
Character
Normal
Slashed
Specifies the style of 0(zero).
SLASHED: SLASH ZERO
Line Pitch
6 LPI
8 LPI
Sets line space.
White
Page Skip
On
Off
Sets ejecting or not ejecting a blank sheet.
Available only when simplex is set.
CR
Function
CR
CR+LF
Sets performance when CR code is
received.
Line
Length
80 column
136 column
Specifies the number of characters per
line.
4-16 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Setup
EPSON
FX
Setup
Settings
Form
Length
45487001TH Rev.1
Admin Setup
Time
Setup
Settings
Date
Format
Functions
Set the format of date.
yyyy/mm/dd
mm/dd/yyyy
*L
0.0inch
0.1inch
~
1.0inch
Left
Margin
0.0inch
0.1inch
~
1.0inch
Sets the amount to shift the horizontal
print start position to the right.
Fit to
Letter
Enable
Disable
Text
Height
Same
Diff
Sets height of a character.
SAME: Regardless of CPI, same height
DIFF: According to CPI, character heights
vary.[Existing model compatible]
Near Life
Status
Enable
Disable
Sets up LED display control for the
occurrence of a near life warning of a
drum, fuser, or belt.
Near Life
LED
Enable
Disable
Sets up LED Lighting control for the
occurrence of a near life warning of a
toner, drum, fuser, or belt.
Idle
Display
Item
Functions
*L Specifies the length of paper.
*A
Sets the position from the top edge of
paper.
TOF
Position
Panel
Setup
11 inch
11.7 inch
12 inch
*L Sets the printing mode that can fit print
*A data, equivalent to 11 inches (66 lines), in
the LETTER-size printable area.
Toner Gauge
Paper Size
Specify display information in idle Display.
Paper Size: Display paper size of each
tray.
Toner Gauge: Display toner gauge.
Panel
Contrast
-10
~
0
~
+10
Tuning the LCD contrast level of the
operator panel.
Invalid
Operation
Volume
Off
Low
High
Set the buzzer volume when invalid
operation.
Error
Volume
Off
Low
High
Set the buzzer volume when error
occurred.
dd/mm/yyyy
*A
Time Zone -12:00
-11:45
-11:30
-11:15
-11:00
~
-1:00
-0:45
-0:30
-0:15
+0:00
+0:15
+0:30
+0:45
+1:00
~
+12:15
+12:30
+12:45
+13:00
Set the time zone(the difference to GMC).
It could be a time between -12:00 to
+13:00, in 15-minute increments.
Daylight
Saving
On
Off
Set the Day light saving.
When it is on, the time goes 1 hour
forward. When it is off, the time goes back.
Time
Setting
2000/01/01 00 :00 Set the current time.
Date is displayed according to the Date
~
2091/12/31 23 :59 Format.
01/01/2000 00 :00
*L
~
12/31/2091 23 :59
01/01/2000 00 :00
*A
~
31/12/2091 23 :59
4-17 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Power Setup
Setup
Others
Setup
RAM
Setup
Settings
Functions
Power
Save
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Power Save Mode.
Sleep
Enable
Disable
Sets Enable/Disable of Sleep Mode.
Auto
Power Off
Enable
Auto Config
Disable
Set the behavior of Auto Power Off.
Disable: Invalidate to go Off mode by time.
Auto Config: The printer does not go to Off
mode when LAN cable is connected, goes
to Off mode when USB or Centro cable is
connected.
Enable: The printer goes to Off mode even
if LAN cable is connected.
Receive
Auto
Buffer Size 0.5 megabyte
1 megabyte
2 megabyte
4 megabyte
8 megabyte
16 megabyte
32 megabyte
Sets the size of receive buffer
Resource
Save
Auto
Off
0.5 megabyte
1 megabyte
2 megabyte
4 megabyte
8 megabyte
16 megabyte
32 megabyte
Sets the size of resource saving area.
This Menu is valid when PCL and other
PDL emulations except PCL are enabled.
Flash
Memory
Setup
Initialize
Execute
Initializes Resident FLASH.
HDD
Setup
Initialize
Execute
This category is displayed only if a an
HDD is installed.
The data stored in the HDD needs to be
deleted.The re-initialization of the partition
is not to be executed.
45487001TH Rev.1
Item
Settings
Admin Others HDD Resize
Setup Setup Setup Partition
PCL nn% nn%
Common
mm%
mm%
PS ll%
ll%
Functions
Specifies the size of partition.
Specifies a size by ratio to the whole HDD
in % (1% unit) .
nn,mm,ll: 1 - 98 and nn+mm+ll=100
(Default values are nn=20, mm=50, II=30.)
<Apply>
Format Partition
PCL
Common
PS
Formats a specified partition.
Erase HDD
Execute
This item appears only when HDD is
installed.
It features of the deletion of all the data
stored in the HDD not to be recovered
them. It aimes at the complete deletion of
printing and individual data left in the HDD
by disposal of the printer and clear data at
return. The printer restart after changing
set-up after menu.
Execute
Resolves mismatch between actual
memory and displayed memory
available in a file system and performs
administration data (FAT information)
recovery. Performs these by file system. Its
takes several tens of seconds to complete
the job of this function. HDD: Performs
recovery only for an HDD.
Execute
Check
All
Sectors
Performs recovery of a defective HDD
sector information and a file system
mismatch mentioned above. The objective
device is only an HDD and it takes 30 to
40 minutes to completed this function for
an HDD of 10GB.
Enable
No
Initializat- Yes
ion
Prevents a setting change accompanying
initialization of BlockDeveice(HDD,FLASH).
Off
Job
Limitation Encrypted Job
Job limitation mode control.
Jobs other than specified ones (Currently,
only encrypted authentication print can be
specified.) are rejected.
Storage
Common
Setup
Security
Setup
Check
File
System
4-18 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Item
Admin Others
Setup Setup
Security
Setup
Settings
Make
Secure
HDD
Execute
Make
Normal
HDD
Execute
Reset
Cipher
Key
Language Language
Setup
Initialize
Job
Cancel
Setup
45487001TH Rev.1
Execute
Functions
Enables the encryption function for data
stored in HDD.
Generates a cipher key and makes the
encryption function (security mode)
information available. In addition, formats
HDD.
Disables the encryption function for data
stored in HDD.
Deletes the cipher key and makes the
encryption function (security mode)
information not available. In addition,
formats HDD.
Resets a cipher key to be used in an
encrypted hard disk.
When this processing is done, all of data
stored in the HDD cannot be restored.
Execute
Initialize the message file loaded in
FLASH.
Cancel
Key
Behavior
Short
Long
Off
Specify the behavior when Cancel button
is pressed in printing.
Short: Cancel the current job by pressing
Cancel button below 2 seconds.
Long: Cancel the current job by pressing
Cancel button in 2 - 5 seconds.
Off: Ingore the press of Cancel button. The
printing can not be cancelled by pressing
cancel button.
Inquiry
Display
On
Off
Specify whether the Job Cancel selection
request will be displayed.
On: Display when Job Cancelling.
Off: Do not displasy.
Focus
Position
Yes
No
Specify the default selection of Job Cancel
request.
Display
Timeout
60
~
180
~
300
Specify the timeout of Job Cancel
selection request. When the time passed,
the printing will be continued as Job
Cancel = No.
Item
Admin Setup
Settings
Change
Password
Settings
Functions
Reset
Settings
Execute
Resets a part of user menu to the factory
default.
Save
Settings
Execute
Saves menus currently set.
With this function, the menus with which
operation was last performed are saved,
and overwrites with them menus that were
previously saved.
Restore
Settings
Execute
Changes to the menu setting saved.
[Conditions for display]
The menu settings are saved.
New
Password
************
Sets a new password to enter "Admin
Setup" menu
From 6 to 12 digits of number or Roman
character can be enter.
Verify
Password
************
Makes User input the new password to
enter "Admin Setup" menu which is set by
"New Password" for confirmation.
From 6 to 12 digits of number or Roman
character can be enter.
*L: The default value for destinations that accept Letter as default.
*A: The default value for destinations that accept A4 as default.
4-19 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2 Self-diagnostic mode
(1) Menu option display switching
LEVEL0
This section describes LEVEL 0 and LEVEL 1.
4.3.2.1 Operator panel
The following description on operating the self-diagnostic is provided, premised on the
following operator panel layout:
ONLINE lamp HELP button
(Green)
MENU
BACK button
button
ONLINE
button
Hold down the BACK or ONLINE button or momentarily press the MENU
or MENU button to display the option shown in a shaded area XXXX .
Use the MENU or MENU button to display the menu option shown in a
non-shaded area XXXX .
Hold down BACK
(for two sec.)
Engine status display
Heater temperature
Environmental information
Numerical
keypad
Low voltage humidity
Hold down ONLINE
(for two sec.)
CH, DB setup table No.
TR setup table No.
TR off setup table No. , belt temperature
Power Save
ATTENTION lamp
button
(Amber)
Self-diagnostic
mode layout
(Overall)
MENU
button
ENTER
button
CANCEL button
(1) Menu option display switching
The level in a shaded area XXXXX can be displayed only from
another one.
Use the MENU or MENU button to display the menu option
shown in a non-shaded area XXXXX .
POWER ON
No buttons pressed
LEVEL0- engine status display
Engine status display
Each voltage display category in
printing
Toner sensor monitor
Toner pulse count monitor
RFID tag noise test monitor
Motor control evaluation function
Error code
Press BACK
45487001TH Rev.1
MENU and ONLINE
held down in combination
(for three sec.)
MENU , MENU , ENTER
and BACK pressed in
combination
Transfer (TR) voltage(1)
Transfer (TR) voltage(2)
DIAGNOSTIC MODE XX.XX.XX -MODE
SWITCH SCAN
MOTOR CLUTCH TEST
TEST PRINT
CONSUMABLE STATUS
PRINTER STATUS
FACTORY MODE SET
SENSOR SETTING
LED HEAD DATA
NVRAM PARAMETER
GRAPHIC PANEL ADJUST
BUZZER TEST
MENU
MENU
Toner sensor
monitor
Toner sensor
status monitor
display
MENU
MENU
Toner pulse count monitor
MENU
Each color toner FULL/
Number of LOW-pulse
detections
Charge (CH) voltage
Supply (SB) voltage
Development (DB)
voltage
Environmental level
MENU , MENU and HELP combination used until System
Maintenance menu appears, and Diagnostic Mode selected
and ENTER pressed
Normal operation mode
Each voltage display
category during printing
Error code
Error code display, etc.
RFID tag noise test monitor
MENU
MENU
Display of number of noise detections/ Toner K error
After elapsed time
correction
Before elapsed time
correction
Transfer (TR) voltage(3)
Motor control evaluating functions
MENU
Regist Motor Constant-Speed Timer
Value/ Environmental Temperature
Fusing Motor Constant-Speed Timer
Value/ Fusing Target Temperature
ID Motor Constant-Speed Timer Value
4-20 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(1) Menu option display switching
LEVEL1
Use the MENU or MENU button to select the option shown in a shaded area ( XXXXX ), and press ENTER to execute the option.
Use ENTER or BACK to display the option shown in a non-shaded area ( XXXXX ), and use the MENU or MENU button to select the option.
Press ENTER to execute a test, and BACK to end the test.
MENU
MENU
DIAGNOSITC MODE XX. XX. XX
-MODE
MENU
MENU
MENU
SWITCH
SCAN
MENU
MOTOR
CLUTCH
TEST
PAPER ROUTE : MENU
PU
ID MOTOR
TONER SENS
FUSER MOTOR
CVO FR TOP
REGIST
CLUTCH
CVO UP_LU_FU
ST_FD
HT
THERMISTER
HUM_TEMP
BELT_T
1ST TAG
2ND TAG
MPT_PE
T1 PE
T1 HOP
T1 CASETTE
SIZE
T2 PE
T2 HOP_FED
T2 CASETTE
SIZE
T2 PNE_UP_CA
T3 PE
REGIST2
CLUTCH
DUPLEX
MOTOR REV
K-ID USED
FUSER UNIT
K-STC MODE CNT
K-TONER (FULL)
K OVER RIDE CNT
MEDIA
*1: TRAY2, TRAY3 and TRAY4
are displayed only when
installed.
T2 HOP
CLUTCH
T2 REG
CLUTCH
T2 LIFT_UP
MOTOR
T3 PNE_UP_CA
T3 LIFT_UP
MOTOR
DUPSNS E
K-ID UNIT
MENU
K-TOTAL DRUM CNT
MENU
TOTAL SHEET CNT
MENU
FACTORY
MODE SET
PRINTER STATUS
MENU
FACTORY
MODE *5
FUSE INTACT
*6
MENU
SENSOR
SETTING
MENU
TONER
SENSOR
MENU
LED HEAD
DATA
MENU
ID UNIT
CHECK
DRUM
OVER LIFE
WR POINT
REV
MENU
NVRAM
PARAMETER
MENU
CLEAR
<Display of LED
HEAD serial No.>
K 01 23
MENU
6789
#############
MENU
BOTTOM
WRT POINT
GRAPHIC
PANEL
ADJUST
CONTRAST
ADJUST
Note:
Hold down the ENTER
button (for three seconds) to
determine a parameter.
BUZZER
TEST
MENU
SMALL
VOLUME
LARGE
VOLUME
DUPLEX
CLUTCH
T3 REG
CLUTCH
DUPSNS
I_R_F_B
MENU
TEST
CASSETTE
*1
DUPLEX
DUPLEX
MOTOR
MENU
CONSUMABLE
STATUS
TEST
PATTERN
MPT HOP
CLUTCH
T3 CASETTE
SIZE
T4 CASETTE
SIZE
PRINT
EXECUTE
PAGE
T3 HOP
CLUTCH
T4 HOP_FED
MENU
T1 HOP
CLUTCH
T3 HOP_FED
T4 PE
MENU
TEST
PRINT
T4 HOP
CLUTCH
<Options for the FACTORY MODE SET Setting> option marked with 5*
FACTORY MODE
FACTORY MODE
The factory operation mode.
SHIPPING MODE
Deselects the factory operation mode.
Note:
Hold down the ENTER button (for three seconds) to determine a parameter.
<Options of the FUSE INT ACT> option marked with *6
FUSE INTACT
FUSE UNIT
INTACT: Not cut/BLOWN: Cut
T4 REG
CLUTCH
POW FAN TEST
FUSER FAN
TEST
ID FAN TEST
ID FAN2 TEST
Note:
The motor keeps rotating if
holding down the ENTER button
for two sec. to determine the
choice of the motor.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-21 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.2 Normal self-diagnostic mode (Level 1)
4.3.2.2.1 Entering self-diagnostic mode (level 1)
The normal self-diagnostic mode menus are as follows:
Option
Self-diagnosis Menu
Adjustment
Maintenance
Utility
Note! Entering the System Maintenance mode of B721/B731/MPS5501
requires a password. Refer to table 4-1 for description on it.
Switch scan test
SWITCH SCAN
Checks input sensor and
switch
No.18
1. Turn on the printer while pressing and holding the BACK, ENTER and ON-LINE button
combination to enter the System Maintenance mode.
Motor clutch test
MOTOR&CLTCH
TEST
Tests the operation of a
motor or clutch.
No.19
2. Press the MENU or MENU button more than one time to display Diagnostic
Mode. Then press the ENTER button to display DIAGNOSTIC MODE.
Test printing
TEST PRINT
Prints a test pattern stored
in the PU.
Consumable
counter display
CONSUMABLE
STATUS
Displays the usage of a
consumable.
No.23
Consumable life
counter display
PRINTER STATUS
Displays the life counter of
a consumable.
No.23
Factory/Shipping
mode switching
FACTORY MODE
SET
Switches between Factory
and Shipping modes
No.3, No.24
Fuse status
display
Engine parameter
setting
Display of LED
head serial
number
Unavailable
Displays the status of a
fuse.
No.24
SENSOR SETTING
Sets whether to enable
or disable error detection
performed by each sensor.
No.25
LED HEAD DATA
Displays the serial number
of LED head data.
Unavailable
10 NVRAM
parameter setting
NVRAM
PARAMETER
Must not be used.
Unavailable
11 Contrast
adjustment
GRAPHIC PANEL
ADJUST
Adjusts the contrast on the
panel.
Unavailable
12 Buzzer test
BUZZER TEST
Buzzer sound test
Unavailable
45487001TH Rev.1
Diagnostic Mode
XX.XX.XX FACTORY/SHIPPING
3. XX.XX.XX on the LCD display identifies the PU firmware version. The FACTORY
WORKING MODE setting is displayed in the right portion of the lower row. The
setting is normally S-MODE, which identifies Shipping.
4. Press the MENU and MENU button to go to each self-diagnostic step (press
the MENU or MENU button to display the next or preceding menu option).
4.3.2.2.2 Exiting self-diagnostic mode
1. Turn of the printer and, after ten seconds, turn it on.
4-22 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.3 Switch scan test
The switch scan test is used for checking entrance sensors and switches.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode (level 1) and, until SWITCH SCAN appears on
the upper display, press the MENU or MENU button (the MENU button
displays the next test option and the MENU button displays the preceding test
option). Then press the ENTER button.
SWITCH SCAN
STKSNS
COVER SW1
TNRSNS
REAR SNS
FU SW
WR2SNS
INSNS2
EXIT SNS
2. Press the MENU or MENU button until an option shown in table 4-3 for the
unit to test appears on the lower display (the MENU button displays the next
option and the MENU button displays the preceding option).
DUPIN SNS
MPTPE SW orSNS
INSNS1
HOPSNS
1stSIZESW
DUPF SNS
3. Press the ENTER button. The switch scan test starts, the units name and
current status being displayed
PESNS
2nd INSNS
2nd HOPSNS
2nd SIZESW
PESNS
PAPER ROUTE:PU
1=H 2=L 3=H 4=L
3rd INSNS
3rd HOPSNS
3rd SIZESW
PESNS
Operate the unit (figure 4-1). Display information on applicable LCD display (the
information displayed vary depending on the sensor.
4th INSNS
4th HOPSNS
4th SIZESW
PESNS
4. Press the CANCEL button. The state in step 2 is restored.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 when necessary.
6. Press the BACK button to end the test (the state in step 1 is restored.
Figure 4-1 Switch sensor locations
45487001TH Rev.1
4-23 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Table 4-3 SWITCH SCAN Detail
<Item having no function> Asterisk mark (*) is displayed in the lower row of display area.
*1: N is displayed when unpopulated the TAG.
*2: "Sensor read value" is displayed when LCF is installed. "*" is displayed when LCF is uninstalled.
1
Display area, upper row
Details
PAPER ROUTE : PU
Entrance sensor 1
TONER SENS
Toner sensor K
CVO UP_LU_FU
Front Cover Open switch
ST_FD
Stacker full sensor
HT THERMISTER
Fuser thermistor, center
sensor
HUM_TEMP
Humidity sensor
BELT_T
Inside Temperature sensor
1ST TAG *1
1st TAG-K UID
2ND TAG *1
2nd TAG-K UID
MPT PE
MPT paper end sensor
T1 PE
Tray 1 paper end sensor
T1 HOP
Tray 1 Hopping Sns
T1 CASETTE SIZE
Size setting switch 1
T2 PE
Tray 2 paper end sensor
T2 HOP_FED
2nd-Hopping Sns
T2 CASETTE SIZE
Size setting switch 1
T2 PNE_UP_CA *2
Tray 2 paper near end
sensor
T3 PE
Tray 3 paper end sensor
T3 HOP_FED
3rd-Hopping Sns
T3 CASETTE SIZE
Size setting switch 1
T3 PNE_UP_CA *2
Tray 3 paper near end
sensor
T4 PE
Tray 4 paper end sensor
T4 HOP_FED
4th-Hopping Sns
T4 CASETTE SIZE
Size setting switch 1
DUPSNS I_R_F_B
Duplex (2-sided printing)
entrance sensor
DUPSNS E
Duplex (2-sided printing)
unit sensor
45487001TH Rev.1
2
Display area,
lower row
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: Light is interrupted
L: Reflected
H: low
L: Full
H: Full
L: low
AD value:
***H
AD value:
***H
AD value:
***H
UID:
***H
UID:
***H
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Paper near end
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Paper near end
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Paper exists
L: No paper
H: Unit installed
L: Unit uninstalled
Details
Entrance sensor 2
Rear Cover Open switch
3
Display area,
lower row
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: Close
L: Open
Temperature sensor
AD value:
***H
Size setting switch 2
Port level H, L
Details
Write sensor
Size setting switch 2
Port level H, L
H: Paper exists
L: No paper
Size setting switch 2
Port level H, L
H: Paper exists
L: No paper
Side thermistor
AD value:
***H
Heater frame thermistor
AD value:
***H
Size setting switch 3
Port level H, L
Size setting switch 4
Port level H, L
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Cassette Open
L: Cassette Close
Size setting switch 4
Port level H, L
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Cassette Open
L: Cassette Close
Size setting switch 4
Port level H, L
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Port level H, L
H: Paper exists
L: No paper
Size setting switch 4
Port level H, L
Size setting switch 3
Tray 2 cassette detect
sensor
Size setting switch 3
Tray 3 cassette detect
sensor
Tray 4 feed sensor
Size setting switch 2
Port level H, L
Exit sensor
Display area,
lower row
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
H: Open
L: Close
Tray 3 feed sensor
Paper upper sensor
Details
Face up Cover Open
switch
Tray 2 feed sensor
Paper upper sensor
4
Display area,
lower row
H: No paper
L: Paper exists
Size setting switch 3
Duplex (2-sided printing)
front sensor
4-24 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.4 Motor and clutch test
The motor and clutch test is used for testing motors and clutches.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode (level 1) and, until MOTOR & CLUTCH TEST
appears on the upper display, press the MENU or MENU button (the
MENU button displays the next test option and the MENU button displays the
preceding test option). Then press the ENTER button.
2. Press the MENU or MENU button until an option shown in table 4-4 for the
unit to test appears on the lower display (the MENU button displays the next
option and the MENU button displays the preceding option).
IDFAN2
ID MOTOR
FUSFAN
REG2 Clutch
DUP SOLENOID
MPT Clutch
MOTOR & CLUTCH TEST
ID MOTOR
3. Press the ENTER button. The motor and clutch test starts, the units the name
and current status starting to blink, and the unit being driven for ten seconds (refer
to figure 4-2).
FUS MOTOR
REAR FAN
DUP MOTOR
DUP Clutch
REG1 Clutch
HOP1 Clutch
POWFAN
HOP MOTOR
2nd REG Clutch
2ndHOP Clutch
HOP MOTOR
Note! The state in step 2 is restored after the unit is driven so. The unit is driven
again by pressing an appropriate button.
By usual printing driving, the clutch solenoid repeatedly is turned on and off (its
motor is driven together with the solenoid when the solenoid cannot be driven
solely for its mechanical structure). * Image drum up-and-down movement
continues until the CANCEL button is pressed.
3rd REG Clutch
3rdHOP Clutch
HOP MOTOR
The clutch solenoid is kept driven by holding down the ENTER button (two
seconds) for a motor to be accepted.
4th REG Clutch
4thHOP Clutch
HOP MOTOR
4. Press the CANCEL button. The state in step 2 is restored.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 when necessary.
6. Press the BACK button to end the test (the state in step 1 is restored).
Figure 4-2
45487001TH Rev.1
4-25 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Table 4-4
Panel display
Driven unit
Condition
ID is removed
ID MOTOR
ID MOTOR
ID Fan1
ID Fan2
POW FAN
FUSER MOTOR
Fuser Motor
REGIST CLUTCH
Hopping Motor
Regist1 Clutch
REGIST2 CLUTCH
Hopping Motor
Regist2 Clutch
T1 HOP CLUTCH
Hopping Motor
Tray1 Hopping Clutch
MPT HOP CLUTCH
Hopping Motor
MPT Clutch
DUPLEX MOTOR
Duplex Motor
Duplex unit is installed
DUPLEX MOTORREV
Duplex Motor
Duplex unit is installed
DUPLEX CLUTCH
Duplex Motor
Duplex Clutch
Duplex unit is installed
T2 HOP CLUTCH
Tray2 Hopping Motor
Tray2 Hopping Clutch
Tray2 is installed
T2 REG CLUTCH
Tray2 Hopping Motor
Tray2 Regist Clutch
Tray2 is installed
T2 LIFT_UP MOTOR
Tray2(LCF) Lift up Motor
LCF is installed for Tray2
T3 HOP CLUTCH
Tray3 Hopping Motor
Tray3 Hopping Clutch
Tray3 is installed
T3 REG CLUTCH
Tray3 Hopping Motor
Tray3 Regist Clutch
Tray3 is installed
T3 LIFT_UP MOTOR
Tray3(LCF) Lift up Motor
LCF is installed for Tray3
T4 HOP CLUTCH
Tray4 Hopping Motor
Tray4 Hopping Clutch
Tray4 is installed
T4 REG CLUTCH
Tray4 Hopping Motor
Tray4 Regist Clutch
Tray4 is installed
POW FAN TEST
Low Volt Fan
FUSER FAN TEST
Fuser FAN
ID FAN TEST
ID Fan
ID FAN2 TEST
ID Fan2
45487001TH Rev.1
4-26 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.5 Test print
The test printing is used for printing test patterns stored in the PU. Other patterns are stored
in the controller.
This test print cannot be used to check the print quality.
Diagnosis for the abnormal print image should be performed in accordance with section 8.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode (level 1) and, until TEST PRINT appears on the
upper display, press the MENU or MENU button (the MENU button displays
the next test option and the MENU button displays the preceding test option).
Then press the ENTER button.
2. A setting option used only in test printing appears on the lower display. Press
the MENU or MENU button until the option to select appears (the MENU
button displays the next option and the MENU button displays the preceding
option). Then press the ENTER button. (Go to step 5 when set to its default, the
option does not need to be set).
3. Keep pressing the MENU , MENU key, and press the ENTER key at the
menu item set by step 2. Then, the setting item is displayed in the upper row of
display area, and the setting value is displayed in the lower row of display area.
Pressing the MENU button displays the next setting and pressing the MENU
button displays the preceding setting (the setting last displayed takes effect.
By pressing the BACK button, the setting is accepted, step 2 being restored.
Repeat step 3 when necessary.
TEST PATTERN
1
45487001TH Rev.1
Display
Settings
Default
Function
PRINT
EXECUTE
Starts printing with the press of the ENTER
button, and ends printing with the press of the
CANCEL button.
TEST
PATTERN
0 to 15: Prints a blank page.
TRAY1
Select the paper feed source.
Not displayed when the tray 2 is not installed.
Not displayed when the tray 3 is not installed.
Not displayed when the tray 4 is not installed.
Sets the number of test copies printed
TEST
TRAY1
CASSETTE
TRAY2
TRAY3
TRAY4
MPT
PAGE
0000
0000
MEDIA
MEDIA TYPE
PLAIN PAPER
CUSTOM LEN
Changes the setting of a TRAY selected in
TEST CASSETTE.
MEDIUM LIGHT
If CUSTOM SIZE is not selected in MEDIA
Letter
SIZE, CUSTOM LEN, and CUSTOM WIDTH
are not displayed.
210
CUSTOM WIDTH
297
MEDIA CHECK
ENABLE
Sets ENABLE/ DISABLE of the paper size
check.
2 PAGES STACK
2 PAGES
STACK
Prints duplex two pages stack layout printing.
2 PAGES STACK: Disables duplex printing
Performs simplex printing.
OFF:
1 PAGES STACK: Prints duplex one page
stack layout printing.
If DUPLEX is not installed, DUPLEX is not
displayed.
MEDIA WEIGHT
MEDIA SIZE
DUPLEX
OFF
1 PAGE STACK
4-27 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Notes! PAGE setting:
By pressing [0] to [9] on the numerical keypad, a number is inputted in the
blinking line.
The input position is shifted with the ONLINE button or CANCEL
button. This setting is incremented by pressing the ONLINE button, and
decremented by pressing the MENU button. Note the setting 0000
endlessly prints pages.
MEDIA Setting Options
MEDIA TYPE
Category
MEDIA
TYPE
Setting value
PLAIN PAPER
LABELS
USERTYPE1
TRANSPARENCY
BOUND
USERTYPE2
LABEL
RECYCLED
USERTYPE3
CARDSTOCK
USERTYPE4
ROUGH
USERTYPE5
LETTERHEAD
MEDIA SIZE
Category
MEDIA
SIZE
CUSTOM size setting:
By pressing [0] to [9] on the numerical keypad, a number is inputted in the
blinking line.
The input position is shifted with the ONLINE button or CANCEL
button. This setting is incremented by pressing the ONLINE button, and
decremented by pressing the MENU button.
* If a display value exceeds the settable range, the setting value is
unavailable.
Setting value
CUSTOM SIZE
LEGAL13
C6
A4
LEGAL13.5
C5
A5
LEGAL14
INDEX CARD(3 5)
A6
MONARCH
ENVELOPE
16K(184 260)mm
B5
COM-9
ENVELOPE
16K(195 270)mm
LETTER
COM-10
ENVELOPE
16K(197 273)mm
EXECUTIVE
DL
STATEMENT
4. When the ENTER key is depressed With PRINT EXECUTE on the lower display
after the operation in step 2, test printing with the setting value set in the steps 2
to 3 is executed.
The test printing is cancelled by pressing the CANCEL button.
When the printer detects any errers in alarm shown in initiating or running the
test printing, it stops the printing and displays the errer on the operation panel.
MEDIA WHIGHT
Category
MEDIA
WEIGHT
45487001TH Rev.1
Setting value
LIGHT
HEAVY
MEDIUM LIGHT
ULTRA HEAVY1
MEDIUM
ULTRA HEAVY2
MEDIUM HEAVY
ULTRA HEAVY3
4-28 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
The displays are switched to the following by pressing the MENU
button when test pattern is printed.
,MENU
DB:k**
P=***
DB: ID number of developping voltages setting table [Unit: HEX]
P: Number of test-print pages (Unit: sheets)
T=*** U=***[###]
H=***%
TR1:k**
TR2:k**
TR1: ID number of transfer voltages parameter VTR1 table [Unit: HEX]
TR2: ID number of transfer voltages parameter VTR2 table [Unit: HEX]
T: = Environment temperature [Unit: C]
U: *** = Upper thermistor current temperature [Unit: C]
[###] = Print execution target temperature [Unit: C]
H: = Environment humidity [Unit: %]
TROFF:**
BELT xxx(***)
TROFF: ID number of transfer OFF voltages setting table [Unit: HEX]
KTR=*.**
BELT: Inner temperature [Unit: C]
(***) is inner temperature thermistor AD value [Unit: HEX]
KTR: BLACK transfer voltages value [Unit: KV]
KR=*.**
KR: BLACK transfer roller resistance value [Unit: uA]
ETMP=***UTMP=***
ETMP: A parameter for correction of constant hopping motor speed (an
environmental temperature) [Unit: DEC].
UTMP: A parameter for correction of constant fuser motor speed (a target
fusing temperature) [Unit: DEC].
45487001TH Rev.1
4-29 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.6 Consumable counter display
The consumable counter display is used for viewing the usage of consumables.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode and, until CONSUMABLE STATUS appears,
press the MENU or MENU button (the MENU button displays the next test
option and the MENU button displays the preceding test option). Then press
the ENTER button.
2. Pressing the MENU or MENU button displays the usage of each consumable
(pressing the ONLINE or CANCEL button is disabled).
3. Press the BACK button to end the option (the state in step 1 is restored).
Upper Display
Lower Display
Format
Unit
Detail
Displays the number of turns
performed by image drum unit
from the first-time installation of it
until present,
*1
K-ID UNIT
******** IMAGES
DEC
Images
K-ID USED
******** %
DEC
FUSER UNIT
******** PRINTS
DEC
Prints
K-TONER
(FULL)
******** %
DEC
K-STC MODE
CNT
******** *8192
DEC
DOT
K OVER RIDE
CNT
******** TIMES
DEC
Times
Displays the usage of ID.
Displays the number of prints
made from the first-time
installation of a fuser unit until
present *2
Displays the usage of toner.
Displays of the printing dot count
numbers of toner.
Displays the extension life
counter value of a toner
cartridge.
*1 One third of the number of drum turns inA4 (A4 portrait) three-pages-per-job printing is
regarded as one count.
*2 Based on the paper length of Legal 13, if the sheet is the legal 13 length or less, it is regarded
as one count, and if the sheet length exceeds the Legal 13 length, the number of counts
is determined by how many times as large is the Legal 13 length as that of the sheet. (the
decimal is rounded out.)
45487001TH Rev.1
4-30 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.7 Print counter display
4.3.2.8 Factory-Shipping mode switching
The print counter display is used for viewing print counter values.
The Factory-Shipping mode switching is used for switching from the Factory to Shipping
mode.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode and, until PRINTER STATUS appears, press the
MENU or MENU button (the MENU button displays the next test option and
the MENU button displays the preceding test option). Then press the ENTER
button.
2. Pressing the MENU or MENU button displays each count printed (pressing
the ONLINE or CANCEL button is disabled).
3. Press the BACK button to end the option (the state in step 1 is restored).
Upper Display
Lower Display
Format
Unit
Function
K-TOTAL
DRUM CNT
******** IMAGES
DEC
Images
Displays the total number of
rotation.
TOTAL SHEET
CNT
******** PRINTS
DEC
Prints
Displays the total number of
images printed.(*1)
*1 Tow counts apply to duplex print.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode and, until the following message appears, press
the MENU or MENU button.
FACTORY MODE SET
2. Press the ENTER button. The following message appears. Press the MENU or
MENU button until the option to set (refer to the table shown below) appears
FACTORY MODE
SHIPPING MODE
3. A setting for the option can be selected by pressing the ENTER button with the
option on the display.
4. Hold down the ENTER button (for three seconds) with the setting on the display.
The setting is stored in the EEPROM. The state in step 2 is restored.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 when necessary.
6. Press the BACK button to end the option (the state in step 1 is restored).
Option
FACTORY
MODE
FUSE INTACT
Settings
Function
FACTORY MODE
Establishes the Factory mode (a fuse-cut
disabling mode).
SHIPPING MODE
Deselects the Factory mode to enable the fusecut function.
FUSE UNIT XXXXXX
Displays the fuse status of the fuser.
Note:
****** is either
INTACT or
BLOWN.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-31 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.9 Self-diagnostic function setting
Option
The self-diagnostic function setting is used for enabling or disabling the error detection by
sensors. The detection can be enabled or disabled temporarily for troubleshooting. Allowing
for setting engine operation options for which expert knowledge is required to be handled.
This self-diagnostic should be used carefully. Be sure to restore the default settings of used
options of the self-diagnostic.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode and, until the following message appears, press
the MENU or MENU button.
Set Settings
Setting Operation
Function
WR POINT
REV
TBL=**H
*.***mm
00H~FFH
A correction value.
Adds a correction value for the
default writing point.
BOTTOM
WRT POINT
TBL=**H
*.***mm
00H~FFH
A tear-off position
value.
Sets a tear-off length from the
bottom edge of paper.
Default is in hatched area.
SENSOR SETTING
2. Press the ENTER button. The following message appears. Press the MENU or
MENU button until the option to set (refer to the table shown below) appears.
TONER SENSOR
ENABLE
3. The setting on the lower display can be selected by pressing the ENTER button.
The MENU button displays the next setting and the MENU button displays
the preceding setting.
4. Hold down the ENTER button (for three seconds) with the desired setting on the
display. The setting is stored in the EEPROM. The state in step 2 is restored.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 when necessary.
6. Press the BACK button to end setting the option (except where not in step 4) (the
state in step 1 is restored).
Option
Set Settings
Setting Operation
ENABLE
Enables detection.
DISABLE
Disables detection.
ID UNIT
CHECK
ENABLE
Enable checking.
DISABLE
Disables checking.
DRUM OVER
LIFE
STOP
Does not extend
life.
CONTINUANCE
Extends life
TONER
SENSOR
45487001TH Rev.1
Function
Enables or disables toner sensor
operation.
Enables or disables image drum
installation checking.
Sets whether to enable or disable
extending image drum life at the end
of the life.
4-32 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.10 LED head serial number display
4.3.2.11 Contrast adjustment
The LED head serial number display is used for viewing whether downloaded data about
LED heads agrees with the serial numbers marked on the LED heads.
This contrast adjustment is used for the adjustment of the panel contrast.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode and, until LED HEAD DATA appears, press the
MENU or MENU button (the MENU button displays the next test option and
the MENU button displays the preceding test option). Then press the ENTER
button.
2. Pressing the MENU or MENU
head data serial numbers.
****
xxxxxxxxxxxxx
**
**
****
xxxxxxxxxxxxx
GRAPHIC PANEL ADJUST
button displays each of the K, Y, M and C LED
3. Press the BACK button to end the option (the state in step 1 is restored).
K ** **
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode (Level 1) and, until the following message
appears, press the MENU or MENU button.
: A revision number
: A serial number
: Head type data
: Light amount data
: Head serial No.
Note! If the serial number of the LED head data is not ASCII code (0x3X/0x4X/0x5X),
it is indicated by . .
2. Pressing the ENTER button displays the adjustment item in the upper display,
and the current setting value in the lower display.
Hold down the MENU
displayed.
CONTRAST MENU
MENU
or MENU
button until the value you want to set is
: The setting value is incremented.
: The setting value is decremented.
CONTRAST ADJUST
1CH
3. Repeat step 2 when necessary.
4. Press the BACK button to end this function (the state in step 1 is restored).
Contrast and lightness adjustment (GRAPHIC PANEL ADJUST)
Display
CONTRAST ADJUST
Setting
Default
0 - 3FH
1CH
Function
Setting of contrast
* Options set are effective in this test mode. (the options are not written in
EEPROM)
In addition, when returning to the normal operation mode, the contrast setting of
the CU side is applied.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-33 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.3.2.12 BUZZER TEST
4.3.3 Printing on stand-alone basis
The BUZZER TEST function is used for the buzzer test.
B721/B731/ES7131/MPS5501b can perform the following printing on a stand-alone-basis.
1. Enter the self-diagnostic mode (Level 1) and, until the following message
appears, press the MENU or MENU button.
Configuration
Prints information, including printer menu settings, program
versions and control block configuration.
Network
Prints network-related information, including a MAC address and
IP address.
Demo Page
Prints demo pages.
File List
Prints a list of files stored in a file system.
PostScript Font List
Prints a PostScript fonts list.
BUZZER TEST
2. Pressing the ENTER button displays the following message.
Hold down the MENU or MENU button until the target option is displayed.
PCL Font List
Prints a PCL emulation fonts list.
BUZZER TEST
IBM PPR Font List
Prints a IBM PPR fonts list.
SMALL VOLUME
EPSON FX Font
List
Prints a EPSON FX fonts list.
Print statistic results
Prints a statistic usage result.
* The result is displayed when Print Statistics Menu-User Report
is set to Enable.
Error Log
Prints an error log.
3. By pressing the ENTER button, the buzzer test starts and the lower display
starts to blink.
* Usually, it stops in 1 second after pressing the Enter button.
* The status is returned to Step 2 after the buzzer for one second, and the buzzer
starts again by pressing the ENTER button again.
Printing Procedure:
4. Pressing the CANCEL button stops the buzzer.
Verify that the message stating the printer is ready to print is showing on the
operator panel, and press the MENU button to display FUNCTION
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 when necessary.
6. Press the BACK button to end the buzzer test (the state in step 1 is restored).
BUSSER TEST
Display
Function
SMALL VOLUME
Buzzer volume is small.
LARGE VOLUME
Buzzer volume is large.
45487001TH Rev.1
Press the MENU
ENTER button.
button to select the option to print printer information. Press the
Press the MENU
button to select the item to print. Press the ENTER button.
Press the ENTER button to print the item (the button must be pressed twice to print
a demo page).
4-34 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4. Maintenance menus
4.3.4 Functions of buttons when/after power-on
After the printer is turned on, buttons on the operator panel of B721/B731/ES7131/
MPS5501b function are described below.
(1) BACK, ENTER and ONLINE buttons for 5 seconds
Start the System Maintenance menu.
(2) BACK, ENTER and CANCEL buttons for 5 seconds
Start the Factory Maintenance menu.
When the printer is turning on, buttons on the operator panel of B721/B731/ES7131/
MPS5501b function are described below.
(3) BACK, MENU
and ENTER buttons
Ignoring all warnings and errors, start the printer, always placing it to an online
mode.
(4) ENTER button
Start the Boot menu.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-35 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.4 Setup after part replacement
Note! When taking out or writing information from/into EEPROM by using
Maintenance Utility, use the procedure shown below to place the printer to the
Forced ONLINE mode before accessing the EEPROM. An error message is
displayed even in the forced ONLINE mode when the printer has an error.
i. When turning on the printer, press and hold down the [Back] and [Menu
] and [Enter] button in combinatoin until STATUS MODE appears on the
operator panel.
ii. When the printer operates properly, the operator panel shows Ready To
Print. However, when the printer has an error, it indicates an error, but the
printer is internally online, being ready to communicate.
The following describes the adjustments necessary after part replacement:
Replaced part
Adjustment
LED head
Not necessary.
Drum cartridge
Not necessary.
Fuser unit
Not necessary.
Belt unit
Not necessary.
PU/ CU board
Copying information stored in EEPROM, which
requires utility software.
4.4.1 Notes on PU/ CU board replacement
1. When the EEPROM on a board to be removed can be accessed (when SERVICE
CALL 104 (Engine EEPROM Error), or 040 (EEPROM Error) is not displayed):
(1) Using the board replacement function of Maintenance Utility (Maintenance
Utility operation manual, section 2.4.1.1.9), take out the information of the
EEPROM on PU and Information of the EEPROM settings on CU from the
board to be removed, and temporarily store it onto an HDD of the computer.
(2) Using the board replacement function of Maintenance Utility (Maintenance
Utility operation manual, section 2.4.1.1.9), copy the information of the
EEPROM on PU stored in HDD of the computer and the information of
EEPROM settings on CU onto the EEPROM of a board to be newly installed.
(3) Even when either information of EEPROM on PU or information of the
EEPROM settings on CU is taken out, using the board replacement function of
Maintenance Utility (Maintenance Utility operation manual, section 2.4.1.1.9),
copy either information of EEPROM on PU or information of the EEPROM
settings on CU which can be stored in the HDD of the computer onto EEPROM
of a board to be newly installed.
Information that cannot be taken out is separately set up in the same function.
When the information of EEPROM on PU cannot be taken out, make a setting
of the serial number on PU (Maintenance utility operation manual, section
2.4.1.1.9.5) and a setting of switching to the Shipping mode (Maintenance utility
operation manual, section 2.4.1.1.9.6) on the setup screen.
When the information of EEPROM settings on CU cannot be taken out, make
a setting of the information about a serial number on CU (Maintenance utility
operation manual, section 2.4.1.1.9.4) on the setup screen.
45487001TH Rev.1
2. When the EEPROM on a board to be removed cannot be accessed:
When SERVICE CALL 104 (Engine EEPROM Error), or 040 (EEPROM Error) is
displayed, or data cannot be read from the EEPROM, after replacing the board to a
new one, follow the following procedure to perform operation by using Maintenance
Utility:
(1) To setting necessary setting as the table below.
Model
B721
B731
ES7131
MPS5501b
Use for
ODA
OEL/AOS
ODA
OEL
AOS
OEL
AOS
ODA
ODB
item of necessary to change the setting
none
none
none
none
Wireless LAN setting
none
Wireless LAN setting
none
paper size and unit
When change the board for B731 AOS/ES7131 AOS,to change the wireless LAN
setting should be valid to invalid.The setting method is following to Maintenance
Utility Manual.
When change the board for MPS5501b ODB,to change the paper size and
unit should be Letter,inch A4,Millimeter.The setting method is following to
Maintenance Utility Manual.
4-36 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(2) Serial number information setting (applicable Maintenance Utility operation
manual, section 2.4.1.1.10.3)
(3) Switching to Shipping mode (applicable Maintenance Utility operation manual,
section 2.4.1.1.10.4)
A SAP serial number is assigned to the printer. The number is placed at the top
of the serial number label of the printer, consisting of total twelve characters -two characters that indicates a production place, two characters that indicates
Ten characters to enter, edited to eleven characters,
preceded by single-byte zero (0)
(0AE01234567)
Revision number
a month and year, six characters that indicates a manufacture number
(sequence number) and two characters that indicates revision number.
For the printer serial number, PU serial number should be selected, and for
the output mode, Display the serial number only should be selected.
When the PU/CU board is replaced with a new one, the printer is placed in the
Factory mode. Switch the printer to the Shipping mode.
To switch, use the Factory/Shipping mode window described in section
2.4.1.1.10.4 Factory/ Shipping Mode in the section 2.4.1.1.10 about board
setup functionality of the Maintenance Utility operation manual.
Note! Replacing the EEPROM (the PU control board) with a new one clears life
information about consumables, including the toner and image drum. Note
that, until the consumables are replaced, this makes differences between
their displayed consumed and consumed lives. Such life information cleared
is as shown below. Upon replacement of the consumables, the information
(counts) except the total number of printed sheets are cleared, and differences
between the counts and consumed lives of the consumables are cleared.
Item
Description
Fuser unit
Fuser unit life count.
A value converted on an A4/
Letter page basis from the
number of pages printed to
date after instrallation of a new
fuser unit.
Image drum black
Imgage drum life count
A value converted on an A4/
Letter page basis from the
number of pages printed to
date after instrallation of a
Print Cartridge or a new image
drum.
Total number of
printed sheets
Printer life count.
The total number of sheets
fed.*1
Print black
Number of pages
printed with an image
The number of pages printed
after installation of a Print
Cartridge or a new image
drum.*1
The PU serial number is ten characters from the SAP serial number. The
rest two characters are the revision number.
The PU serial number is set in the PU serial number setting window
described in section 2.4.1.1.10.3 of the Maintenance Utility operation manual
in the section 2.4.1.1.10 about Board setup functionality.
To assign a PU serial number to the printer, in the PU serial number
setting window, enter eleven characters, i.e. ten characters preceded by
a singlebyte zero (0) (note a read PU serial number is ten characters). As
shown in the following serial number label example, the ten characters are
the printers the SAP serial number excluding the revision number.
Serial number label example
The PU serial number is shown at Printer Serial Number in the header of
the printers configuration report (a Menu Map) output from the printer. After
the PU serial number is changed, it can be checked by printing the report
from the printer.
45487001TH Rev.1
Count description
*1 Two counts apply to duplex print.
4-37 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.5 Manual density adjustment setting
C811/C822/C831/C841 is shipped with the auto density adjustment mode enabled. When the
mode is disabled by a user, the printer may print density out of adjustment while being used.
Manually perform density adjustment setting when the printer prints an improper density.
Note! The setting must be performed with the printer in a static state. Do not perform
it while the printer warms up.
(1) Press the MENU or MENU button more than one time. Press the ENTER
button when Calibration appears.
(2) Press the MENU
ENTER button.
or MENU
button to select Adjust Density Execute. Press the
(3) Press the ENTER button.
Auto density adjustment starts, the operator panel display providing a message
stating that density is being adjusted.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-38 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
4.6 Boot Menu List
To display Boot Menu, turn on the printer while holding down the [ENTER] button.
Memo Displaying Boot Menu requires entry of a password. The password defaults to
six a (aaaaaa).
Category
HDD
Setup
Item
Settings
Item
Settings
************
Enter a password to enter Boot menu.
The default value is "aaaaaa"
From 6 to 12 digits of numbers or Roman
character to input.
Enable
HDD
No
Yes
Even if a machine is inoperable at installation
because an HDD has been damaged, you can
make the machine operable by setting to No to
deal with that no HDD is attached regardless of
existence of an HDD. While No is set, access
to an HDD results in FAIL because the HDD
is regarded as not attached even if the HDD is
normal.
After the setting change and exit from the menu,
the printer restarts.
[Conditions for display]
HDD implementation
Function
Storage Check File Execute
Common System
Setup
Resolves mismatch between actual memory and
displayed memory available in a file system and
performs administration data (FAT information)
recovery. Performs these by file system. Its takes
several tens of seconds to complete the job of
this function. HDD: Performs recovery only for
an HDD.
The following message appears after pressing
the Enter switch.
Are You Sure?
Yes
No
If No is selected, the display will be back to the
former menu. If Yes is selected, this function
initiates.
[Condition for display]
HDD insertion("Yes" is selected in "Boot Menu""HDD Setup"-"Enable HDD.")
Check All
Sectors
Performs recovery of a defective HDD sector
information and a file system mismatch
mentioned above. The objective device is
only an HDD and it takes 30 to 40 minutes to
completed this function for an HDD of 10GB.
The following message appears after pressing
the Enter switch.
Are You Sure?
Yes
No
If No is selected, the display will be back to the
former menu. If Yes is selected, this function
initiates.
[Condition for display]
HDD insertion("Yes" is selected in "Boot Menu""HDD Setup"-"Enable HDD.")
Function
Enter
Password
45487001TH Rev.1
Category
Execute
4-39 /
4. Maintenance menus
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Category
Item
Settings
Function
Menu
Lockout
On
Off
Set On/Off of Menu Lockout function
On: Menus exept for "Print Secure Job" become
invisible.
Off: This function doesn't work.
Panel
Lockout
Mode1
Mode2
Off
Set On/Off of Menu Lockout function.
Mode1: All keys except for Online, Cancel,
Power Save, and Help, aren't have any
reaction.
Mode2: All keys except for Online aren't have
any reaction.
Off: This function doesn't work.
* When Mode1/2 is set, USB Memory Interface
will be Disable automatically. And when
panel lockout is turned off, the USB Memory
Interface is still Disable.
45487001TH Rev.1
4-40 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Cleaning
5.1 Cleaning......................................................................................5-2
5.2 LED lens array cleaning...............................................................5-3
5.3 Paper feed rollers cleaning..........................................................5-6
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Cleaning
5.1 Cleaning
The inside and outside of the printer must be cleaned with a dry cleaning cloth and a
handy vacuum cleaner when necessary.
Note! Do not directly touch the image drum terminals, LED lens array and the
LED head connectors.
45487001TH Rev.1
5-2 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5.2 LED lens array cleaning
The LED lens array must be cleaned when a vertical white belt or line (void or light print)
occurs on the printed side.
LED head cleaning
When a white line or blurred text is printed, perform the following steps shown below.
(1) Press the power switch for about one second.
White belt or line
(void or light print)
The message Shutting down/Please wait. Printer will turn off automatically.
appears in the operator panel, and the power switch indicator blinks every 1
second. Then the printer turns off automatically and the power switch indicator
goes out.
Disconnect the AC power cable, the Ethernet cable, and the USB cable.
Power switch
(2) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
Front cover open lever
45487001TH Rev.1
5-3 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Cover the removed ID unit with paper so that it will not be exposed to light.
(3) Open the top cover.
Possible to get burned.
Do not touch the fuser unit. It is hot.
Top cover
(6) Lightly wipe the lenses of the LED heads with soft tissue paper.
Note! Do not use the solvents such as methyl alcohol or thinner for cleaning the
LED head lens because they can damage the LED head.
(4) Remove the ID unit and place it on a flat surface.
LED head
ID unit
45487001TH Rev.1
5-4 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(7) Set ID unit in the printer.
(9) Close the front cover.
Note! The front cover cannot be closed if the top cover is not closed securely.
(8) Close the top cover.
45487001TH Rev.1
5-5 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5.3 Paper feed roller cleaning
If paper jams occur frequently, clean the paper feed rollers.
(3) Wipe the retard roller on the tray with a wet cloth that has been wrung out well.
(4) Return the paper tray to the printer.
Note! Use a soft cloth to clean the paper feed rollers so as not to damage their
surfaces.
For Trays 1/2/3/4
Note! This procedure images use tray 1 as an example, but the same procedure
applies to trays 2/3/4.
(1) Pull out the paper tray.
Retard roller
(2) Wipe the two paper feed rollers inside the printer with a wet cloth that has been
wrung out well.
Paper feed roller
45487001TH Rev.1
5-6 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
For MP Tray
(3) Open the paper set cover.
(1) Open the MP Tray forward by inserting your fingers into the front recesses.
MP tray
Paper set cover
(2) Release the tab of the paper feed roller cover by pressing the right arm inward
while lifting up the MP Tray lightly, and release the tab on the left side in the
same mannaer.
(4) Wipe the two paper feed rollers with a wet cloth that has been wrung out well.
Tab
Paper feed roller
Tab
45487001TH Rev.1
5-7 /
5. Cleaning
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Open the retard roller cover forward while pressing the center part of the MP
Tray. Wipe the retard roller with a wet cloth that has been wrung out well.
(7) Lower the paper set cover.
Retard roller
Paper set cover
Retard roller cover
(8) Hook one tab of the paper feed roller cover by pressing the right arm inward
while lifting up the MP Tray lightly, and hook the tab on the left side in the same
procedure.
(6) Close the retard roller cover.
Tab
Retard roller cover
Tab
(9) Close the MP Tray.
45487001TH Rev.1
5-8 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6. Troubleshooting procedure
6.1 Important notes to start the repair work.....................................6-2
6.2 Matters to be checked before taking corrective actions
against abnormalities.................................................................6-2
6.3 Precautions when taking corrective actions
against abnormalities.................................................................6-2
6.4 Preparation for troubleshooting..................................................6-2
6.5 Troubleshooting methods...........................................................6-3
6.6 Paper cassette switches and paper size correlation table........6-84
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6. Troubleshooting procedure
6.1 Important notes to start the repair work
(1) Read the basic check/inspection points described in Users Manual.
(2) Get information from customers in detail as much as possible about problem
occurrence conditions.
(3) Carry out checking under the conditions that are similar to those at occurrence of
the problem.
6.2 Matters to be checked before taking corrective actions against abnormalities
(1) The operation environment of the printer is appropriate.
(2) Consumable items (toner cartridges and image drums) have been replaced
properly.
(3) Print media (paper) has no problem. Refer to paper specifications in Users Manual.
(4) The image drums are installed correctly.
6.3 Precautions when taking corrective actions against abnormalities
(1) Do not touch the OPC drum surface with your hand and do not allow any foreign
materials to touch it.
(2) Do not expose the OPC drum to the direct sunlight.
(3) The fuser unit is extremely hot. Do not touch.
(4) Do not expose image drums to any light for 5 minutes or longer at room
temperature.
6.4 Preparation for troubleshooting
(1) Error status of this printer is displayed on the LCD (Liquid crystal display) screen of
the operator panel.
Take appropriate troubleshooting actions by following the message displayed on the
LCD screen.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-2 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5 Troubleshooting methods
When a trouble occurs with this printer, perform troubleshooting by following the steps
described below.
6.5.1 LCD message list
Initializing
Trouble occurs
The trouble that
is indicated by
LCD messages
Abnormal printed
images (and the
trouble that is not
indicated by LCD
messages)
45487001TH Rev.1
Panel display
Perform
troubleshooting by
referring to the "LCD
message list. (Refer
to section 6.5.1.)
Perform more detailed
troubleshooting by using
the Troubleshooting Flow.
(Refer to section 6.5.2.)
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Initializing
Off
Off
It displays, while not having determined the
system display language immediately after
turning on a power supply.
Initializing
Off
Off
The controller side is initializing.
EEPROM Reset
Off
Off
Indicates that EEPROM of the controller
side is being reset.
The condition that EEPROM is reset
includes the followings.
Changes of CU ROM (when disagreement
of CU F/W version is detected)
Changes of destination channel
Compulsive initialization of EEPROM
(System maintenance menu)
OEM set of PJL command
RAM Check
nnn%
Off
Off
RAM checking. The rate of checked capacity
to the total capacity is displayed on the 2nd
line.
Wait a Moment
Network Initializing
Off
Off
The network is in initializing.
Checking File System
Off
Off
Displays that HDD file system is being
checked.
Process Check of File System is valid to
start from "Storage Common Setup"-"Check
File System" of Boot Menu or Admin Setup.
Perform more detailed
troubleshooting by using
Troubleshooting Flow.
(Refer to section 6.5.3.)
6-3 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Checking Sectors
nnn%
PU Flash Error
Communication Error
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Beep
Details
Normal
ATTENREADY
TION
represents a blank line.) indicator indicator
LCD Status Message
Displays that a sector of HDD is being
checked.
Check process of the sector is valid to start
from "Storage Common Setup"-"Check All
Sectors" of Boot Menu or Admin Setup.
nnn
Percentage of checked capacity
It is shown that the PU firmware could not
be started normally.
This status may occur also in a user
environment. When it occurs, the
maintenance by a maintenance member is
required.
Displays that communication to PU firmware
failed within the initializing phase.
This status may not occur in a user
environment. When it occurs, the
maintenance by a maintenance member is
required.
Details
Ready To Print
On
Off
Shows on-line status.
Offline
Off
Off
Shows off-line status.
* Ready LED in off-line is always assumed to
be Off.
File Accessing
Varies Varies
The status showing FILE SYSTEM (HDD/
FLASH) is being accessed.
Data Arrive
Varies Varies
Data receiving, process not started yet.
Displayed mainly during PJL process without
text print data or during job spooling.
Processing
Blink Varies
Data receiving or output processing
Data Present
Varies Varies
Un-printed data remains in Buffer. Waiting for
data to follow.
Printing (%TRAY%)
Varies Varies
A printer is printing.
%TRAY%
Tray1
Tray2
Tray3
Tray4
MPTray
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Print Demo Page
Varies Varies
Printing Demo Pages
Printer Font
Varies Varies
Printing Font Lists
Print Network Config
Varies Varies
It is shown that a network setup is printing.
Print Configuration
Varies Varies
Printing Menu Maps
Printer File List
Varies Varies
Printing File Lists
Print Error Log
Varies Varies
Printing Error Logs
Varies Varies
Collate printing. iii: The number of copy
in printing. jjj: the total number of printing.
When the total number of printing is 1, it is a
normal printing display.
Collate Copy iii/jjj
45487001TH Rev.1
Beep
6-4 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies Varies
Beep
Details
Copy printing. kkk: The number of pages
in printing. lll: The total number of printing.
When the number of copy is 1, it is a normal
printing display.
Copy kkk/lll
Verifying Job
Blink Varies
Indicates that the integrity of print data for
encrypted authentication is being verified (for
corruption and tampering).
Cancelling Job
Blink Varies
Indicates that job cancellation has been
instructed and data is being ignored until
the job completion.
Cancelling Job
Blink Varies
Indicates if JAM occurs when Jam Recover
is OFF, that job cancellation has been
instructed and data is being ignored until the
job completion.
Cancelling Job
Blink Varies
Indicates a job being cancelled due to no
print permit. (Related to JobAccount)
(A job received from a user who is denied
printing.)
Cancelling Job
Blink Varies
Indicates that a job is being cancelled
because the printer area where the logs are
stored has been used up and also "Cancel
job" is specified as an operation at the time of
Log Full. (Related to JobAccount)
Cancelling ...
Blink Varies
Canceling reading the data from USB
memory because an error has occurred.
Varies Varies
Indicates the period of reading from
or writing to the memory tags in toner
cartridge/image drum unit.
Calibrating
Varies Varies
Shows cooling down status.
It is cautious of a period "," following
"Adjusting Temp".
Varies Varies
Indicates that the printer is warming up.
Adjusting Temp.
Adjusting Temp
45487001TH Rev.1
Beep
Details
Varies Varies
A printer is in power save mode. Displayed
in a combination of other message in the
first line.
LCD back light extincts in the energy saving
mode and blinks after that modebrightens
after exiting that mode. If the power is on
during the energy saving mode, it lights up
and extincts after 30 seconds. However, the
energy saming mode remains.
Also, it lights up in the priority 365 in shut
down process.
From the power-saving mode, when the
time going to SleEPmode is passed, printer
enters Sleep Mode.
Varies Varies
On
With the printer unable to switch to the
Power Save mode, pops up with a press
or successive presses of the power save
button, and three seconds after that,
disappears, the display being restored.
Varies Varies
Indicates the printer goes into the Sleep
Mode. The printer goes into the mode
immediately after this message appears,
and in fact the message is hard to read.
Flash Download
Varies Varies
Downloading PU F/W (This is not user-level
error)
This function is secret to users. Therefore,
this status does not occur in a user
environment.
Please wait
Executing
Maintenance
Varies Blink
Indicates that the printer is executing the
remote maintenance mode. During this
mode, users have no permission to operate
the printer.
Varies Varies
When USB memory is installed, printer
starts to get file list from USB memory. This
status will be displayed until getting file list
finished.
Power Save
Invalid Operation
Sleep Mode
Getting file list ...
Varies Varies
Optimizing Temp
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
Indicates that printing has been suspended
for a while due to high temperature of the
drum, or the printer is in a wait state to cope
with heat at the time of switching narrow
paper to wide paper.
6-5 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies Varies
Beep
Details
Indicates that the new consumable (toner).
This status should be appeared at detecting
the new consumable (toner), and be
disappeared automatically after 3 seconds.
%INFO% is contained in the consumable
tag.
Wait a Moment
Network Initializing
Varies Varies
Wait a Moment
Message Data
Processing
Varies Varies
Indicates that message data to be updated
is being processed.
Wait a Moment
Varies Varies
Message Data Writing
Indicates that message data to be updated
is being written.
Varies Varies
Indicates that message data to be updated
has been written successfully.
45487001TH Rev.1
ATTENREADY
TION
represents a blank line.) indicator indicator
LCD Status Message
%INFO%
Power Off/On
Message Data
Received OK
Warning
This appears when the NIC initialization is
occurred, as the setting was changed.
Varies Off
Details
The life of printer go to the end.
When print page count reached
1200000 and pjl command
OKIPRINTERLIFESUPPORT is set
to ON, this status will be raised.
Toner amount is low. Displayed in
a combination of other message in
the first line.
In case of MENU "Menus""System Adjust"-"Low Toner"=Stop
, ATTENTION LED blinks and the
printer shifts to OFF Line.
When an ONLINE switch is pushed,
or when arbitrary errors occur and
the error is canceled, an off-line
state is canceled, and printing is
continued until it is set to Toner
Empty.
"TONER LOW" status occurs
when the power is on, the LED of
ATTENTION in a case of MENU
"Menus"-"System Adjust"-"Low
Toner"=Stop is blinked and go back
to the off line after the initializing
process.
It is possible to operate untill
"TONER EMPTY" by pressing
"ONLINE switch".
Moreover, when set as Admin
Setup "Panel Setup"-"Near Life
LED"=Disable, Attention LED is
switched off.
Printer Life
Toner Low
Remedial
measure
Beep
Varies On
(Blink) (On)
(Off)
6-6 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Print Cartridge
Near Life
Beep
Varies On
(Blink) (On)
(Off)
Varies On
Non OEM Toner
Detected
Details
Print Cartridge amount is low.
Displayed in a combination of other
message in the first line.
Printing is continued until it is set to
Print Cartridge Empty.
Moreover, when set as Admin
Setup "Panel Setup"-"Near Life
LED"=Disable, Attention LED is
switched off.
It shows the toner cartridge of
authorized 3rd party. (Tag Licensed to
3rd party)
Urge the
user to
use proper
toner
cartridge.
It shows the Print Cartridge of
authorized 3rd party. (Tag Licensed to
3rd party)
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Varies On
The Region ID of toner cartridge
is not proper to the distribution
channel.
Urge the
user to
use proper
toner
cartridge.
Varies On
The Region ID of Print Cartridge
is not proper to the distribution
channel.
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Varies On
The chip of Tag is not compatible.
Urge the
user to
use proper
toner
cartridge.
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Non Genuine Toner
Varies On
The chip of Tag on Print Cartridge is
not compatible.
Varies On
Something is wrong with the toner
sensor.
Non Genuine Print
Cartridge
45487001TH Rev.1
Beep
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Image Drum Near
Life
Print Cartridge Near
Life
Fuser Unit Near
Life
Details
Remedial
measure
Interpreter detects an error due
to the following reason. Receive
data after this is ignored until the
job completion. When the job
is completely received, this is
automatically cleared.
- The job has a grammatical error.
- The page is complicated, and VM
was used up.
Varies On
(Off)
The life of the drum (warning).
Displayed in a combination of other
message in the first line. The printer
stops at the point when it reaches
the drum life (Shifts to error, OFFLINE.)
Moreover, when set as Admin Setup
"Panel Setup"-"NearLifeLED" =
"Disable", Attention LED is switched
off.
Varies On
(Off)
The life of the Print Cartridge (warning).
Displayed in a combination of other
message in the first line. The printer
stops at the point when it reaches the
drum life (Shifts to error, OFF-LINE.)
Moreover, when set as Admin Setup
"Panel Setup"-"NearLifeLED" =
"Disable", Attention LED is switched
off.
Varies On
(Off)
Notifies the fuser unit is near its life.
Moreover, when set as Admin Setup
"Panel Setup"-"NearLifeLED" =
"Disable", Attention LED is switched
off.
Blink Varies
Error Postscript
Incompatible Toner
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
Varies On
Non OEM Print
Cartridge Detected
Toner Sensor Error
Remedial
measure
6-7 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies On
Details
Notifies the life of the fuser unit
(warning). Displayed in a combination
of other message in the first line.
Warning only (No Life error).
This appears when the cover was
opened and closed just after the fuser
life error occurred.
Replace
the fuser
with a new
fuser.
Notifies toner is empty.
This status message (warning) is
displayed when opening/closing
a cover or turning power on again
after the toner empty error occurs.
Replace
the toner
cartridge
with a
new toner
cartridge.
Notifies the toner cartridge is not
installed.
Install
the toner
cartridge.
Remember
that the toner
cartridge
supplied with
the product
cannot
be used if
the toner
cartridge of
other supply
is used.
Change Fuser Unit
Varies On
Toner Empty
Varies On
Toner Not Installed
Varies On
Print Cartridge Not
Installed
45487001TH Rev.1
Remedial
measure
Beep
Notifies the Print Cartridge is not
installed.
Install
the Print
Cartridge.
Remember
that the Print
Cartridge
supplied with
the product
cannot
be used if
the toner
cartridge of
other supply
is used.
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Details
Varies On
It shows the image drum of authorized
3rd party. (Tag Licensed to 3rd party)
Urge the
user to
use proper
image
drums.
Varies On
It shows the Print Cartridge (drum) of
authorized 3rd party. (Tag Licensed to
3rd party)
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Varies On
The Region ID of image drum is not
proper to the distribution channel.
Urge the
user to
use proper
image
drums.
Varies On
The Region ID of Print Cartridge
(drum) is not proper to the distribution
channel.
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Varies On
The chip of Tag is not compatible.
Urge the
user to
use proper
image
drums.
Varies On
The chip of Tag is not compatible.
Urge the
user to use
proper Print
Cartridge.
Varies On
Notifies the life of the drum. This is a
warning only.
This appears when the cover was
opened and closed just after the drum
life error occurred.
Replace
the image
drum with a
new image
drum.
Varies On
Notifies the life of the Print
Cartridge(drum). This is a warning
only.
This appears when the cover was
opened and closed just after the drum
life error occurred.
Replace
the Print
Non OEM Image
Drum Detected
Non OEM Print
Cartridge Detected
Incompatible Image
Drum Detected
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Non Genuine Image
Drum
Non Genuine Print
Cartridge
Image Drum Life
Print Cartridge Life
Remedial
measure
Beep
Cartridge
with a
new Print
Cartridge.
6-8 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies On
Beep
Image Drum Life,
%PAGES% Pages
Left
Varies On
Print Cartridge Life,
%PAGES% Pages
Left
Notifies the prolonged period of the
Print Cartridge life, after reached
its limitation, by the operator's
requirement.
%PAGES%
1~100
Replace
the image
drum with a
new image
drum.
Notifies the prolonged period of the
Print Cartridge life, after reached
its limitation, by the operator's
requirement.
%PAGES%
1~100
Replace
the Print
with a
new Print
Cartridge.
Notifies the last prolonged period of
the image drum life.
This appears after the hidden
operation was done at the life
limitation.
Replace
the image
drum with a
new image
drum.
Varies On
Notifies the last prolonged period of
the Print Cartridge life.
This appears after the hidden
operation was done at the life
limitation.
Replace
the Print
Varies On
The tray is empty. Treated as
Warning until printing to the empty
tray is designated.
%TRAY%
Tray1
Tray2
Tray3
Tray4
MPTray
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at
tray2's position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at
tray3's position.
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Details
Varies On
Lift Up Error has occurred to Tray.
That tray is treated "Paper Empty" as
a result, and printing from that tray
becomes disabled.
%TRAY%
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's
position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's
position.
Remove
the tray
and put it
back in the
printer.
Varies On
Displays that there is too much paper
in Tray. This is a warning; thus,
printing will not stop.
%TRAY%
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's
position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's
position.
Remove
excess
paper from
the tray.
Varies On
Disk-full is occurring. Because this is a
temporary warning, it remains until the
end of the job and disappears.
Explain the
user that
no remedial
measure is
required.
Varies On
An attempt to write in a read-only file
was done. Because this is a temporary
warning, it remains until the end of the
job and disappears.
Explain the
user that
no remedial
measure is
required.
Varies On
Indicates that a secret file is being
erased.
Varies On
It indicares the deletion of encrypted
authentication print job and saving of
deletion request of file.
Varies On
Indicates that a secret file waiting to
be erased is full.
%TRAY% Lift Up
Error
%TRAY%
Overfilled
Cartridge
with a
new Print
Cartridge.
Load paper
in the
indicated
tray.
File System is Full
File System is
Write Protected
File Erasing
Deleting Encrypted
Job
Erased Data Full
Remedial
measure
Beep
Cartridge
Print Cartridge Life,
Print Quality Not
Guaranteed
45487001TH Rev.1
Remedial
measure
Varies On
Image Drum Life,
Print Quality Not
Guaranteed
%TRAY% Empty
Details
6-9 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies Varies
Beep
Details
PU flush error (Error occurs during
the alteration of PU firm ware or it
failed in the alteration in PU flush of
such as LED Head information.)
%PUFLASH%
PU
Tray2
Tray3
Tray4
%PUFLASH% Flash
Error
Varies Varies
Accounting Log
Buffer is near full
Indicates that the USB hub is
connected, which is not supported by
the printer.
This status should be displayed until
unconnection of that USB hub.
Remove
the USB
Hub.
Indicates that the USB device is
connected, which is not supported by
the printer.
This status should be displayed until
unconnection of that USB device.
Remove
the USB
device.
45487001TH Rev.1
Details
Varies Varies
Memory overflow was occurred in the
collate copy. Stays displayed until the
ONLINE button is pressed.
Reduce
the number
of pages
that are
going to be
printed at a
time.
Varies On
Notifies users that jobs have been
cancelled because they are not
permitted for printing.
(Related to JobAccount).
Stays displayed until the ONLINE
button is pressed.
Set the
user ID
of the job
account
in the
printer
driver.
If the user
ID has
been set
in the
driver,
check the
user ID
and its
setting
with
the job
account
administrator.
Varies On
Notifies users that jobs have been
cancelled because the log buffer is
full.
(Related to JobAccount.)
Stays displayed until the ONLINE
button is pressed.
Execute
[Acquire
immediately] on the
server PC
with the
print job
accounting.
Press ONLINE
Button
Varies Varies
Varies Varies
Please detach it
It indicates the Job Accounting log
buffer is near full.
Log Buffer is Full.
Job Rejected
Press ONLINE
Button
Remedial
measure
Beep
Print Restricted.
Job Rejected
The function isn't accepted because
log buffer is full. (Related to
JobAccount).
This message is displayed, if the
log buffer is full and "Operation at
Log Full" in Job Accounting Server
Software is set to "Delete old logs".
The new jobs will be able to execute
after the following operations.
1. The log in the unit must be got by
Job Accounting Server Software.
2. The setting of "Operation at Log
Full" must be changed to "Does not
acquire logs".
Please detach it
Press ONLINE
Button
USB Hub
Unsupported
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
Collate Fail: Too
Many Pages
Varies Varies
Accounting Log
Buffer Full(Delete
old logs)
Unsupported USB
Device Detected
Remedial
measure
6-10 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies On
Details
A disk error is occurred, which is
other than the file system fill or the
disk write protected. Operation that
does not involve a disk is available.
nnn: An identifier to Error type (For
details, see the overview chapter.)
%FS_ERR%
= 0 GENERAL ERROR
= 1 VOLUME NOT AVAILABLE
= 3 FILE NOT FOUND
= 4 NO FREE FILE
DESCRIPTORS
= 5 INVALID NUMBER OF
BYTES
= 6 FILE ALREADY EXISTS
= 7 ILLEGAL NAME
= 8 CANT DEL ROOT
= 9 NOT FILE
= 10 NOT DIRECTORY
= 11 NOT SAME VOLUME
= 12 READ ONLY
= 13 ROOT DIR FULL
= 14 DIR NOT EMPTY
= 15 BAD DISK
= 16 NO LABEL
= 17 INVALID PARAMETER
= 18 NO CONTIG SPACE
= 19 CANT CHANGE ROOT
= 20 FD OBSOLETE
= 21 DELETED
= 22 NO BLOCK DEVICE
= 23 BAD SEEK
= 24 INTERNAL ERROR
= 25 WRITE ONLY
Replace
the HDD.
Indicates that a job has been deleted
because corruption of data has been
detected by the integrity verification in
authentication printing.
Press the
ON LINE
button.
File System
Operation Error
<nnn>
Press ONLINE
Button
Varies Varies
Invalid Secure Data
Press ONLINE
Button
45487001TH Rev.1
Remedial
measure
Beep
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Beep
Details
Varies Varies
Invalid data was received. Press
the On-line switch and eliminate
the warning. Displayed when
unsupported PDL command is
received or a spool command is
received without HDD.
Varies Varies
The Job Accounting log is not
registered correctly because of thr
disc access error is occurred during
accounting log writing into HDD
(Related to Logging).
This message is displayed until
Online key pressed.
Varies Varies
An error in the content of PDF file.
Varies Varies
The password of the encrypted PDF
is different with the one inputed. The
file will not be printed.
Varies Varies
The PDF is limited not be printed by
a password. The owner password is
required.
Varies Varies
An error occurred when writing PDF
cache.
If there is not a HDD installed, add
an optional RAM or HDD.
If there is a HDD installed, increase
available space on HDD.
Invalid Data
Press ONLINE
Button
Accounting Log
Writing Error
Press ONLINE
Button
Remedial
measure
Press the
ON LINE
button.
Error PDF
Press ONLINE
Button
Invalid Password
Press ONLINE
Button
Password required
to print
Press ONLINE
Button
PDF Cache Write
Error
Press ONLINE
Button
6-11 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
represents a blank line.)
indicator
LCD Status Message
(
Varies Varies
Beep
Details
Decode error has occurred in a PDF
file.
Decode error
occurred
Varies Varies
Press ONLINE
Button
When the printer detects an unrecoverable error, the following service call error is displayed
on the LCD.
Service call
nnn: error
Note! nnn indicates an error code.
Press ONLINE
Button
Can not read the
file
Remedial
measure
Cannot read the file from USB
Memory while printing from USB
Memory. The USB Memory may be
pulled out, or damaged, or file can
not open.
When a service call error is displayed, the error code and the associated error information
are displayed in the lines under that on the LCD screen at the same time.
Be sure to take note of this error information (numerals indicating address and so on) and
inform it to the related departments because the information is used for trouble analysis and
solution. Meaning of error codes and remedial measures are shown in Tables 6-1-1 and 6-12.
Table 6-1-1 Operator alarm
LCD Status
Message
Install Paper
MPTray
%MEDIA_SIZE%
Press ONLINE
Button
45487001TH Rev.1
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
On
Off
Beep
Details
Manual paper feed is required.
Manually insert the paper shown by
%MEDIA_SIZE%.
The unit of paper size in Custom:
The unit specified for MPTray (menu
setting) is used if no unit is specified
by the driver. When the driver
specifies a unit, the unit is used for
display.
Paper size displays in Custom mode:
"<width>x<length> <unit>"
ex.) 210x297 mm
8.5x11.0 inch
Error
code
Error
(ONLINE)
6-12 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Change Paper in
%TRAY%
%MEDIA_SIZE%
%MEDIA_TYPE%
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Beep
Details
On
The media type in the tray and the
print data do not match. Load proper
paper in the tray (It takes a while until
the status disappears after you have
closed the tray and the lever lifted.)
(%TRAY%:TrayName, %MEDIA_
SIZE%:PaperName, %MEDIA_
TYPE%:MediaTypeName)
Error 661 : Tray1
Error 662 : Tray2
Error 663 : Tray3
Error 664 : Tray4
Error 662 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 663 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Paper size displays in Custom mode:
"<width>x<length> <unit>"
ex.) 210x297 mm
8.5x11.0 inch
The unit of paper size in Custom: The
unit specified for MPTray (menu setting)
is used if no unit is specified by the driver.
When the driver specifies a unit, the unit
is used for display.
As a user pressed ONLINE key, the
printer could ignore this error at the just
printing job.
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Error
code
LCD Status
Message
Error
661
662
663
664
Change Paper in
MPTray
%MEDIA_SIZE%
%MEDIA_TYPE%
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Off
Change Paper in
%TRAY%
%MEDIA_SIZE%
%MEDIA_TYPE%
Off
Please see HELP
for details
Error
code
Beep
Details
Blink
On
The media type in the tray and the print
data do not match. Load proper paper in
the tray (It takes a while until the status
disappears after you have closed the
tray and the lever lifted.) (%MEDIA_
SIZE%:PaperName, %MEDIA_
TYPE%:MediaTypeName)
Error 660 : MPTray
Paper size displays in Custom mode:
"<width>x<length> <unit>"
ex.) 210x297 mm
8.5x11.0 inch
The unit of paper size in Custom: The
unit specified for MPTray (menu setting)
is used if no unit is specified by the driver.
When the driver specifies a unit, the unit
is used for display.
A user needs to press ONLINE key after
changing the paper.
Error
660
Blink
On
The size of paper or media type in the
tray does not match the print data.
Load paper in tray. (It takes a while
until the status disappears after you
have closed the tray and the lever
lifted.)
Error 461 : Tray1
Error 462 : Tray2
Error 463 : Tray3
Error 464 : Tray4
Error 462 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 463 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position
The paper size displaying form of the
custom mode is the same as above.
Paper size displays in Custom mode:
"<width>x<length> <unit>"
ex.) 210x297 mm
8.5x11.0 inch
As a user pressed ONLINE key, the
printer could ignore this error at the
just printing job.
If Media_Size has both portrait and
landscape, %MEDIA_SIZE% displays
icon which indicate paper orientation
after Paper Size.
Error
461
462
463
464
6-13 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Change Paper in
MPTray
%MEDIA_SIZE%
%MEDIA_TYPE%
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Install Paper
MPTray
%MEDIA_SIZE%
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Off
Blink
Blink
Error
code
LCD Status
Message
The size of paper or media type in the
tray does not match the print data.
Load paper in tray
(It takes a while until the status
disappears after you have closed the
tray and the lever lifted.)
Error 460 : MPTray
The paper size displaying form of the
custom mode is the same as above.
Paper size displays in Custom mode:
"<width>x<length> <unit>"
ex.) 210x297 mm
8.5x11.0 inch
A user needs to press ONLINE key
after changing the paper.
Error
460
Remove Paper
Face Down Stacker
IPrinting request is issued to an empty
MPTray.
If it goes through a definite period of
time (PU firmware holds time(3 sec))
after a user places paper, a printer will
lift up the multipurpose tray, and will
perform re-feeding.
If a user pushes the ONLINE button
before timeout, the printer perform
also re-feeding.
Error 490 : MPTray
In this state, Leisus I/F : corresponding
bits of both LFTERR and LFTERR2
should be '0'.
Programmer's note: When the
ONLINE button was pressed,
the controller (CU) should send
MPTPECLR command to the engine
(PU). The engine would clear this
state after receiving that command.
This error is occurred, when the
MPTray is in the home position and
the sensor "PE SNS2" cannot detect
papers.
Error
490
Beep
Details
On
On
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Error
code
Off
Blink
On
The printed paper is overfilled on the
paper stacker of the printer unit.
Error 480 : Face Down Stacker
Error
480
Off
Blink
On
Memory capacity overflows due to the
following reason.
Press ON-LINE switch so that it
continues. Install expansion RAM or
decrease the data amount.
- Too much print data in a page.
- Too much Macro data.
- Too much DLL data.
- After frame buffer compression, over
flow occurred.
Error
420
Off
Blink
On
Memory capacity overflows due to the
following reason when printing from
USB memory.
Press ON-LINE switch so that it
continues. Install expansion RAM or
decrease the data amount.
- Too much print data in a page.
- Too much Macro data.
- Too much DLL data.
- After frame buffer compression, over
flow occurred.
Error
420
Off
Blink
On
An error occurred at the
communication with wireless bridge.
For example, response timeout, etc.
This status only for wireless LAN
printer.
Error
517
Please see HELP
for details
Press ONLINE
Button for
Restoration
Memory Overflow
Please see HELP
for details
Press ONLINE
Button for
Restoration
Memory Overflow
Please see HELP
for details
Wireless startup
failed
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
6-14 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
This wireless
firmware version
does not operate
on this device
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Error
code
Off
Blink
On
The major version is not the same
with wireless bridge.
This status only for wireless LAN
printer.
Error
504
Off
Blink
On
Wireless LAN can not startup. Some
setting need to be re-configured.
This status only for wireless LAN
printer.
Error
505
Off
Blink
On
Can not setup communication with an
Access Point(there is not an usable
AP).
This status only for wireless LAN
printer.
LCD Status
Message
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Not connected to
wireless access
point
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Error
506
(ONLINE)
Error
code
Check Data
Message Data
Write Error
<%CODE%>
Varies Varies On
Indicates that writing of message data
Error
(ONLINE)
to be uploaded has been failed.
%CODE% is a decimal value (one
digit) and represents the cause of
failure in writing.
= 1 FAIL: Other errors.
= 2 DATA_ERROR: Hash check
error in data reading/writing, or
abnormal FLASH
= 3 OVERFLOW: Downloading
failure due to FLASH memory
full at starting or during writing
in a language file
= 4 MEMORYFULL: Memory
reservation failure
= 5 UNSUPPORTED_DATA:
Downloading data unsupported
on the printer
Firmware Update
Error
Please try again
Varies Varies On
FW Update was failed.
Press ONLINE
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Wireless settings
are incomplete
Details
When this error occured, the FW
Update needs to be executed again,
and the printer needs to keep OnLine.
If network doesn't
work, please try
firmware update
over USB
Face Up Stacker
Open
Duplex Not
Available
Off
Blink
On
It is occurred when duplex printing
pages are added at the face up
stacker cover opened.
Error
(ONLINE)
Error
581
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
6-15 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Install Paper
%TRAY%
%MEDIA_SIZE%
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
Printing request is issued to an empty
tray.
Load paper.
(It takes a while until the status
disappears after you have closed the
tray and the lever lifted.)
Error 491 : Tray1
Error 492 : Tray2
Error 493 : Tray3
Error 494 : Tray4
Error 492 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 493 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
The paper size displaying form of the
custom mode is the same as above.
Error
491
492
493
494
Remove Excess
Paper
%TRAY%
On
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Blink
On
Print request was made to Tray, which
has been detected to have too much
paper.
This status will be cleared when
excess paper is removed from that
tray and the tray is put back in.
%TRAY%
Error 531 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 532 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Error
531
532
Off
Blink
On
Indicates that paper feed is
unavailable in attempting to print from
Tray 1 due to removal of the paper
cassette of Tray 1. (Occurs only when
Tray 2 has been installed.)
%TRAY%
Error 430 : Tray1
Error 431 : Tray2
Error 432 : Tray3
Error 433 : Tray4
Error 431 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 432 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Error
430
431
432
433
Install Toner
For Maximum
Performance
Always Use
%COMPANY_
NAME% Original
This should be appeared after the
toner empty error messages when
OKIORIGINALCONSUMABLEDISPLAY is
ON to display this.
Install New Image
Drum
For Maximum
Performance
Always Use
%COMPANY_
NAME% Original
This should be appeared after the
drum life error messages when
OKIORIGINALCONSUMABLEDISPLAY is
ON to display this.
Install Paper
Cassette
%TRAY%
Blink
On
Indicates removal of the paper
cassette of Tray 1 that is a paper path
in attempting to print from Tray 2, 3, 4,
or LCF.
Error 440 : Tray1
Error 441 : Tray2
Error 442 : Tray3
Error
440
441
442
Off
Blink
On
Print request was made to Tray, to which Tray
Lift Up Error has occurred.
Lift Up Retry will take place when the tray is
removed and put back in.
%TRAY%
Error 521 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 522 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Error
521
522
Error
code
Off
Please see HELP
for details
Off
Please see HELP
for details
Reset Tray
%TRAY%
LCD Status
Message
Details
Please see HELP
for details
Install Paper
Cassette
%TRAY%
Error
code
Beep
Please see HELP
for details
6-16 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Install New Print
Cartridge
For Maximum
Performance
Always Use
%COMPANY_
NAME% Original
Install Toner
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Beep
Details
This should be appeared after the print
cartridge life error messages when
OKIORIGINALCONSUMABLEDISPLAY is
ON to display this.
On
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Print
Cartridge
Print Cartridge Life
Off
Blink
On
To Exceed the
Life, Press Online
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Toner
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
LCD Status
Message
Incompatible Toner
Off
Blink
On
Off
Blink
On
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Toner ends.
Error 413 : Black
Toner empty warning status takes
effect at Cover Open/Close.
When you did elimination of
(cancelling) print data, it can not turn
into warning (only for K).
Error
413
Print Cartridge ends.
Error 413 : Black
The operator can prolong the life
temporarily by pressing the Online
button.
Error
413
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Error
code
Off
Blink
On
The signature ID of toner cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
and the group of signature ID is not
proper (OEM channel mismatch).
Error 617 : Black
Error
617
Off
Blink
On
The signature ID of Print Cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
and the group of signature ID is not
proper (OEM channel mismatch).
Error 617 : Black
Error
617
Off
Blink
On
The signature ID of toner cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
and the group of signature ID is
protected (OEM mismatch).
Error 623 : Black
Error
623
Off
Blink
On
The signature ID of Print Cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
and the group of signature ID is
protected (OEM mismatch).
Error 623 : Black
Error
623
Off
Blink
On
The signature ID of toner cartridge
can not be recognized (Unauthorized
third party).
As probable missing to measure the
amount of toner, the printer notifies
error status and stop printing.
Error 553 : Black
The engine is confirmed again by
cover open/close.
And, when the toner cartridges have
not been exchanged, it shifts to
Warning.
And, it is possible to print up to 20.
Error
553
Please see HELP
for details
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Toner
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Error
code
The signature ID of toner cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
but the group of signature ID is proper
(OKI regional mismatch).
As probable missing to measure the
amount of toner, the printer notifies
error status and stop printing.
Error 557 : Black
Error
557
The signature ID of Print Cartridge is
not proper to the distribution channel,
but the group of signature ID is proper
(OKI regional mismatch).
As probable missing to measure the
amount of toner, the printer notifies
error status and stop printing.
Error 557 : Black
Error
557
Please see HELP
for details
Non Genuine Toner
Please see HELP
for details
6-17 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Non Genuine Print
Cartridge
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Off
Blink
Off
Blink
On
On
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Image
Drum
Off
Blink
The signature ID of Print Cartridge
can not be recognized (Unauthorized
third party).
As probable missing to measure the
amount of toner, the printer notifies
error status and stop printing.
Error 553 : Black
The engine is confirmed again by
cover open/close.
And, when the toner cartridges have
not been exchanged, it shifts to
Warning.
And, it is possible to print up to 20.
Error
553
Incompatible Image
Drum
The toner cartridge is not installed.
Error 613 : Black
The engine is confirmed again by cover
open/close.
And, when the toner cartridges have
not been exchanged, it shifts to Warning.
And, it is possible to print up to 20.
Error
613
The Print Cartridge is not installed.
Error 613 : Black
The engine is confirmed again by cover
open/close.
And, when the toner cartridges have
not been exchanged, it shifts to Warning.
And, it is possible to print up to 20.
Error
613
The image drum unit is not proper to
the distribution channel (OKI channel
mismatch).
Error 693 : Black
Error
693
On
Please see HELP
for details
Print Cartridge Not
Installed
LCD Status
Message
Details
Please see HELP
for details
Toner Not Installed
Error
code
Beep
On
Off
Blink
On
The Print Cartridge(image drum uni)
t is not proper to the distribution
channel (OKI channel mismatch).
Error 693 : Black
Beep
Details
Error
code
Off
Blink
On
The image drum unit is not proper to
the distribution channel (OEM channel
mismatch).
Error 703 : Black
Error
703
Off
Blink
On
The Print Cartridge(image drum
unit) is not proper to the distribution
channel (OEM channel mismatch).
Error 703 : Black
Error
703
Off
Blink
On
The image drum unit is not proper to
the distribution channel, and the group
ID is protected (OEM mismatch).
Error 707 : Black
Error
707
Off
Blink
On
The Print Cartridge(image drum
unit) is not proper to the distribution
channel, and the group ID is protected
(OEM mismatch).
Error 707 : Black
Error
707
Off
Blink
On
The image drum unit can not be
recognized (Unauthorized third party).
Error 687 : Black
Error
687
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Image
Drum
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Error
693
Please see HELP
for details
Incompatible Print
Cartridge
Please see HELP
for details
Non Genuine
Image Drum
Please see HELP
for details
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
6-18 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Non Genuine Print
Cartridge
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Beep
Details
On
The Print Cartridge(image drum unit)
can not be recognized (Unauthorized
third party).
Error 687 : Black
Error
code
Error
687
Off
Blink
On
The image drum unit can not be
detected by the signature control
system.
Error 697 : Black
Error
697
Off
Blink
On
The Print Cartridge(image drum unit)
can not be detected by the signature
control system.
Error 697 : Black
Error
697
Off
Open Cassette
Paper Remain
%TRAY%
Off
Please see HELP
for details
Blink
Blink
On
On
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
Unknown Consumable detected. Use
a special startup(Press Cancel when
power on) to start the printer to online, but a history will be recorded.
Error
709
Additional paper is detected when a
paper jam has occurred.
Error 632 : Tray2 Cassette
Error 633 : Tray3 Cassette
Error 634 : Tray4 Cassette
Error 632 : Tray2(LCF) Cassette
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 633 : Tray3(LCF) Cassette
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error
632
633
634
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
Error
code
Blink
On
Additional paper is detected when a
paper jam has occurred.
Error 637 : J0: Paper Feed Path
Error
637
Off
Blink
On
Additional paper is detected when a
paper jam has occurred.
Error 638 : J1: Paper Transport Path
Error
638
Off
Blink
On
Additional paper is detected when a
paper jam has occurred.
Error 639 : J2: Paper Exit Path
Error 640 : J4: Duplex Entry Path
Error
639
640
Off
Blink
On
Additional paper is detected when a
paper jam has occurred.
Error 641 : J5: Duplex Reversal Path
Error 642 : J3: Duplex Transport Path
Error
641
642
Off
Blink
On
Something is wrong with the toner
sensor.
This status is indicated in Shipping
Mode only.
If the same error is detected in
FACTORY Mode, it is indicated as
service call of 163.
Error 543 : Black
Error
543
Off
Blink
On
Something is wrong with the toner
sensor.
This status is indicated in Shipping
Mode only.
If the same error is detected in
FACTORY Mode, it is indicated as
service call of 163.
Error 543 : Black
Error
543
Please see HELP
for details
Toner Sensor Error
Please see HELP
for details
Print Cartridge
Sensor Error
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
Details
Off
Please see HELP
for details
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Remain
Please see HELP
for details
Caution, unknown
Consumable
detected
Go to User Manual
"Trouble Shooting"
to restore operation
Beep
Please see HELP
for details
Please see HELP
for details
Print Cartridge Not
Installed
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Front Cover
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Please see HELP
for details
Please see HELP
for details
Image Drum Not
Installed
LCD Status
Message
6-19 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Check Paper
Paper Multi Feed
%TRAY%
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Off
Blink
Details
On
Warns that inappropriate long paper
has been fed from the tray. Check
whether Multi-feed has happened.
Recovery Print takes place at Cover
Open/Close, allowing the operation to
continue.
%TRAY%
Tray1
Tray2
Tray3
Tray4
MPTray
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Error
401
Inappropriate size paper was fed from
a tray. Check the paper in the tray or
check for Multiple-feed. Open and
close the cover to perform recovery
printing, and continue.
%TRAY%
Tray1
Tray2
Tray3
Tray4
MPTray
Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray3's position.
Error
400
IPaper jam occurred during paper
feeding from tray.
Error 390 : MP Tray
Error
390
Please see HELP
for details
Check Paper
Paper Size Error
%TRAY%
Off
Blink
On
Please see HELP
for details
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
Please see HELP
for details
Off
Blink
Error
code
Beep
On
LCD Status
Message
Open Cassette
Paper Jam
%TRAY%
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Off
Blink
On
Paper jam occurred during paper
feeding from tray.
Error 391 : Tray1
Error 392 : Tray2
Error 393 : Tray3
Error 394 : Tray4
Error 392 : Tray2(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error 393 : Tray3(LCF)
*When LCF is installed at tray2's position.
Error
391
392
393
394
Off
Blink
On
Jam has occurred in paper path.
Error 380 : Feed
Error
380
Off
Blink
On
Jam has occurred in paper path.
Error 381 : Transport
Error
381
Off
Blink
On
Jam has occurred in paper path.
Error 382 : Exit
Error 383 : Duplex Entry
Error 385 : Fuser Unit
Error
382
383
385
Off
Blink
On
Indicates stop printing because the
face up stacker was operated while
printing, and to have assumed the
error.
Error
409
Off
Blink
On
Jam has occurred nearby DUPLEX
unit.
Error 371 : Duplex Input
Error
371
Please see HELP
for details
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
Error
code
Please see HELP
for details
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
Please see HELP
for details
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
Please see HELP
for details
Open Front Cover
Face Up Stacker
Error
Please see HELP
for details
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Jam
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
6-20 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Error
code
LCD Status
Message
Install New Image
Drum
Printing disabled
due to low
threshold of Image
Drum life
Off
Blink
On
Jam has occurred nearby DUPLEX
unit.
Error 372 : Misfeed from Duplex
Error
372
Off
Blink
On
The toner empty error is occurred
after the image drum reached its life.
Error 563 : Black
This is displayed until a user
exchanges the image drum.
Error
563
The toner empty error is occurred
after the image drum reached its life.
Error 563 : Black
This is displayed until a user
exchanges the image drum.
Error
563
Notifies the life of the drum.
The operator can prolong the life
temporarily by pressing the Online
button.
Error 567 : Black
Error
567
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Image
Drum
Image Drum Life
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Print
Cartridge
Print Cartridge Life
Off
Blink
On
Off
Blink
On
To Exceed the
Life, Press Online
Button
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Print
Cartridge
Print Cartridge Life
To Exceed the
Life, Press Online
Button
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
Off
Blink
On
Notifies the life of the Print
Cartridge(drum).
The operator can prolong the life
temporarily by pressing the Online
button.
Error 567 : Black
Beep
Details
Error
code
Off
Blink
On
Notifies the life of the drum absolutely.
This status is appeared after the end
of the prolonged period.
Error 683 : Black
Error
683
Off
Blink
On
Notifies the life of the Print Cartridge
absolutely.
This status is appeared after the end
of the prolonged period.
Error 683 : Black
Error
683
Off
Blink
On
Notifies the fuser has reached its life.
This is the error displayed based on
the counter to indicate that the fuser
has reached its life, and printing will
stop.
Warning status takes effect at Cover
Open/Close.
Error
354
Off
Blink
On
Indicates that no toner is supplied to (is
detected in) the printer. This error is
possibly caused by installing the toner
cartridge with being unlocked with its
lock lever, or its protective tape not
removed.
Error 547 : Black
Error
547
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Print
Cartridge
Printing disabled
due to low
threshold of Print
Cartridge life
Please see HELP
for details
Please see HELP
for details
Install New Image
Drum
Image Drum Life
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Install New Fuser
Unit
Fuser Unit Life
Please see HELP
for details
Error
567
Check Toner
Cartridge
Improper Lock
Lever Position
Please see HELP
for details
6-21 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
Check Print
Cartridge
Improper Lock
Lever Position
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Off
Blink
On
Shows that the toner cartridge lever
has not been locked.
Indicates that no toner is supplied to (is
detected in) the printer. This error is
possibly caused by installing the Print
Cartridge with being unlocked with its
lock lever, or its protective tape not
removed.
Error 547 : Black
Error
547
Off
Blink
On
The image drum is not correctly
installed.
Error 343 : Black
Error
343
Please see HELP
for details
Check Image Drum
Error
code
Please see HELP
for details
Check Print
Cartridge
Off
Blink
On
The image drum is not correctly
installed.
Error 343 : Black
Error
343
Please see HELP
for details
Check Fuser Unit
Off
Blink
On
The fuser unit is not correctly installed.
Error
320
Please see HELP
for details
Close Cover
%COVER%
Please see HELP
for details
45487001TH Rev.1
Off
Blink
On
The cover is open.
Error 310 : Top Cover
Error 311 : Front Cover
Error 587: Rear Cover
Error
310
311
587
LCD Status
Message
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Error
code
Wait a Moment
Rebooting <n>
Off
On
Rebooting of the controller unit.
%CODE% is a decimal value (one
digit) and represents the reason to
reboot.
= 0 Reboot due to a reason
other than the followings.
= 1 Reboot due to
PJLCommand.
= 2 Reboot in accordance with a
menu change.
= 3 Reboot due to quit operator
of PostScript Language.
= 4 reboot by Network Utility
(including Web).
Error
Shutting down
Please wait.
Printer will turn off
automatically.
Off
Off
It is shown that a printer is shutting
down.
Shutdown processing is started with
which press power button after the
completion of initialization processing
of a printer.
Error
Turn off power
Shutdown
completed
Off
Off
It is shown that the printer completed
shutdown processing. (The backlight
of LCD puts out the light)
Error
Power Off and Wait
for a while
126:Condensing
Error
Off
Blink
On
A dew is formed.
(Fatal Error is not available in national
language. )
Fatal
126
Power Off/On
nnn:Error
Off
Blink
On
A fatal error occurred.
For details refer to Table 8-1-2 Service
Call Error List.
Fatal
<nnn>
Power Off/On
nnn:Error *
Off
Blink
On
A fatal error occurred.
'*' specifies the detailed error cause.
For details refer to Table 8-1-2 Service
Call Error List.
Fatal
070
072
073
075
203
204
6-22 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
LCD Status
Message
ATTENREADY
TION
indicator
indicator
Beep
Details
Error
code
Service Call
nnn:Error *
Off
Blink
On
A fatal error occurred.
'*' specifies the detailed error cause.
For details refer to Table 8-1-2 Service
Call Error List.
Fatal
128
166
168
169
231
Power Off/On
nnn:Error
PC:nnnnnnnn
LR:nnnnnnnn
FR:nnnnnnnn
Off
Blink
On
A fatal error occurred.
For details refer to Table 8-1-2 Service
Call Error List.
'nnnnnnnn' specifies the detailed error
cause.
Fatal
002~011
F0C
F0D
FFE
FFF
Power Off/On
209:Download
Error
Off
Blink
On
Downloading Media Table to PU has
failed.
(Related to CustomMediaType.)
Fatal
209
Table 6-1-2 Service Call Error List
Panel display
Service Call
001: Error
Check details
Power Off/On
009: Error
PC: nnnnnnnn
LR: nnnnnnnn
FR: nnnnnnnn
CPU unexpected
exception
Power Off/On
010: Error
PC: nnnnnnnn
LR: nnnnnnnn
FR: nnnnnnnn
CPU unexpected
exception
Power Off/On
011: Error
PC: nnnnnnnn
LR: nnnnnnnn
FR: nnnnnnnn
CPU unexpected
exception
Service Call
030: Error
CU RAM Check
Error
Service Call
031: Error
CU Optional RAM
Check Error
Result
Solution
Replace the PU/
CU board.
Machine Check
Exception
Hardware fault
detected.(Board
defectiveness or
Shortage of power
supply volume)
CPU unexpected
Power Off/On
002: Error to 007: exception
Error
PC: nnnnnnnn
LR: nnnnnnnn
FR: nnnnnnnn
Service Call
040: Error
45487001TH Rev.1
Cause
Does error display
reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error display
reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error display
reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error display
reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does this error
message reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Is error recovered by
replacing RAM DIMM?
No Reset RAM DIMM
Yes Replace program
RAM DIMM.
No Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error display
reappear?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Is RAM DIMM set
properly?
CU EEPROM Error
6-23 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Service Call
042: Error, 043:
Error, 045: Error
Cause
Flash File System
Error
Check details
Failed access to Flash
set directly on PU/CU
board.
Result
Solution
Run forced
initialization of
Flash.(Note that
NIC- F/W and
Mac address is
deleted.After the
initialization,it is
need to download
NIC-F/W and /
or Mac address
by Maintenance
utility.)Press"+,","CAN-CELto
turn power ON .
Replace the PU/CU
board if symptom
does not change.
1) Replace the PU/
CU board with
the one for the
proper head.
2) Replace with a
head of proper
resolution.
Service Call
049: Error
LED head type
(resolution) error
LED Head type was
mismatched with CU
and Engine.
Service Call
051: Error
CU Fan Error
Abnormal CPU
cooling fan on PU/
CU board.
Is CU Fan connector
set properly?
Is error recovered by
replacing fan?
No Connect Properly.
Yes Replace fan.
No Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
052: Error
DMA Abort Error
detected in Image
processor.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Service Call
067: Error
SleepMode
Interface Monitor I/F
error with CU F/W.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
45487001TH Rev.1
Panel display
Cause
Check details
Result
Solution
Service Call
069: Error
The NIC device had
not worked correctly. Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
070: Error
PSE firmware fault
was detected.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
072: Error
Engine I/F error
between PU-CU.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
073: Error
Video Error; Fault
detected when
image data was
extended.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
075: Error
Video Error; Fault
detected when
image data was
extended.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
077: Error
The video
decompress fault
was detected on
the image data
expansion.
Service Call
081: Error
The CU initializer
detected an error in
the backuped data.
Service Call
104: Error
Engine EEPROM
Does error reoccur?
setting check was
OK when power ON.
Then detect read/
write error.
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Service Call
106: Error
Abnormal engine
control logic.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Service Call
112: Error
Detected illegal 2nd
Tray.
Is a 2nd Tray provided
for this model installed?
No
Install a correct
2nd Tray.
Service Call
113: Error
Detected illegal 3rd
Tray.
Is a 3rd Tray provided
for this model installed?
No
Install a correct 3rd
Tray.
Service Call
114: Error
Detected illegal 4th
Tray.
Is a 4th Tray provided
for this model installed?
No
Install a correct 4th
Tray.
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
6-24 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Service Call
121: Error
Service Call
122: Error
Cause
Check details
High-voltage power
supply I/F error.
Is cable between PU
board and high-voltage
power unit connected
properly?
Is there no improperly
connections?
No Connect properly.
Yes Check improper
connections for
high-voltage.
No Replace the higevoltage power
supply.
Is the FAN (bottom
right of the front) of
the low voltage power
supply block working?
No
Low-voltage power
supply FAN error.
Low-voltage power
supply temperature
error.
Is the FAN connector
connected correctly?
Service Call
123: Error
Abnormal
environment humidty
/Not connected
humidity sensor.
Service Call
124: Error
Abnormal
environment
temperature.
Power Off/On
126: Error
Condensation in
the printer was
detected.
Service Call
127: Error
Error detected at the
fuser unit cooling
FAN.
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Is the FAN connector
connected properly?
Solution
Check connections
for connector of
the FAN.
Yes Replace the lowvoltage power
supply.
No Replace the FAN.
Yes Replace the lowvoltage power
supply.
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the control
panel board (PCQ
board).
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the control
panel board (PCQ
board).
Condensation iss likely
to occur in printers
carried from the outside.
Turn on the printer
again after it is exposed
to room temperature for
two hours to half a day.
Does the error reoccur? Yes
Does error reoccur?
45487001TH Rev.1
Result
After leaving the
printer at room
temperature, turn
on the power
again.
Panel display
Service Call
128: Error
Service Call
134: Error
Cause
Check details
Error detected at the
engine FAN motors.
05: Fuser side FAN
08: REAR FAN
0B: ID FAN 2
Is the FAN connector
connected properly?
LED head fault
detected.
(134=K)
Is LED head properly
set?
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Service Call
155: Error
Fuser unit
fuse cannot be
disconnected.
Is fuser unit set
properly?
Does error reoccur?
Service call
163: Error
Error detected
by toner sensor.
(163=K)
This error does
not occur with the
factory default
settings.
Is toner cartridge
setting?
Is toner lock lever
setting?
Does error reoccur?
Result
Solution
No
Connect properly
again.
Yes Replace the FAN
motor.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
No
Set properly for
LED head unit.
Yes Turn power ON
agein.
Yes Replace LED head
unit
No
After cleaning for
fuser connector,
reset.
Yes Turn power ON
again.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
No
Set toner cartridge.
No
Turn a lock lever
of toner to a fixed
position.
Yes Replace toner
sensor or
assembly.
Replace the control
panel board (PCQ
board).
No
Connect properly
again.
Yes Replace the FAN
motor.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
6-25 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Service Call
166: Error
Cause
An abnormality
was detected with
the power supply
temperature
thermistor.
01: Short
02: Open
03: High temp.
04: Low temp.
Check details
01, 02:
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
03:
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
04:
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
45487001TH Rev.1
Result
Solution
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Yes Replace the cable
between the low
voltage power
supply unit and the
PU/CU board.
Remove anything
obstructing the
ventilation slots if
any and restore
the power.
Yes Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Yes Replace the cable
between the low
voltage power
supply unit and the
PU/CU board.
Raise the room
temperature and
restore the power.
Yes Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Yes Replace the cable
between the low
voltage power
supply unit and the
PU/CU board.
Panel display
Service Call
167: Error
Service Call
168: Error
Service Call
169: Error
Cause
ThermistorSlope
Error
Result
Solution
Is the error message
displayed?
Does error reoccur?
Yes Power Off/On.
Compensation
Thermistor Error
01: Short
02: Open
03: High temp.
04: Low temp.
Is the error message
displayed?
Does error reoccur?
Yes Power Off/On.
Upper Side
Thermistor Error
01: Short
02: Open
03: High temp.
04: Low temp.
Is the error message
displayed?
Does error reoccur?
Yes Power Off/On.
Service Call
170: Error, 171:
Error
Short circuit in fuser
thermistor or open
detected.
Service Call
172: Error, 173:
Error
Abnormal
temperature
detected by fuser
thermistor
(high-temp or low
temp.)
Option unit I/F
Service Call
182: Error to 184: error
182=Tray2
Error
183=Tray3
184=Tray4
Power Off/On
190: Error
Check details
System Memory
Overflow.
Yes After leaving the
printer for 30
minutes, turn on
the printer again.
Yes After leaving the
printer for 30
minutes, turn on
the printer again.
Yes After leaving the
printer for 30
minutes, turn on
the printer again.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the fuser
unit.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the fuser
unit.
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
Error occured while
PU Firmware
Service call
writing over the PU
200: Error to 202: download Error.
firmware.
(These problems
Error
are not occurred in
the usual operating.)
Power Off/On.
Yes After checking
connention parts of
connector,replace
option unit.
Power Off/On.
Yes Add option RAM
DIMM.
Turn the printer
OFF/ON, and retry
to download the PU
firmware again.
6-26 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Power Off/On
203: Error, 204:
Error
Power Off/On
207: Error, 208:
Error
Cause
Check details
An error was
detected of the CU
program.
(These problems
are not occurred in
the usual operating.)
Reinstall the PU/CU
board.
Is the error message
displayed again?
An error was
detected of the CU
program.
(These problems
are not occurred in
the usual operating.)
Reinstall the PU/CU
board.
Is the error message
displayed again?
Downloading Media
Table to PU has failure.
(Related to Custom
Media Type)
Power Off/On
209: Download
Error
Media Table
download Error.
(This problem is
not occurred in the
usual operating.)
Power Off/On
213: Error, 214:
Error
Error occurred while
An error was
printing
detected of the CU
program.
(These problems
are not occurred in
the usual operating.)
45487001TH Rev.1
Result
Solution
After turn power
OFF, check
connections
between CU board
and PU board.
Then turn power
ON again.
After turn power
OFF, check
connections
between CU board
and PU board.
Then turn power
ON again.
Turn the printer
OFF/ON, and
retry to download
again.
After turn power
OFF, check
connections
between CU board
and PU board.
Then turn power
ON again.
Panel display
Service Call
231: Error
Cause
Tag Interface Error
05: K reader (TC/ID)
- Tag interface
connection error
11: K reader (TC/ID)
- Tag interface
connection error
Check details
05, 11:
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur
after the power
restoration?
Is the Tag cable
connected properly?
Does error reoccur
after the power
restoration?
Result
Solution
Yes Replace the toner
cartridge, ID or
Print Cartridge.
Yes Check the Tag
cable.
No
Connect the cable
properly.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Power Off/On
250: Error
Secure File Erasing
Error
Did the user accept to
execute Erase HDD?
Inform the user
that it is necessary
to execute Disk
ERASE to restore
the HDD defaults
in order to delete
the encrypted file.
Service Call
251: Error
Secure Disk Erasing
Error
Error occurred during
Disk ERASE.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the HDD.
6-27 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Cause
Check details
Result
Solution
An unexcepted error
Does error reoccur?
occurred during
initializing the
security mode. Error
cause information
was displayed after
an error number.
Power Off/On.
Yes Regenerate an
encryption key. If it
doesnt solve the
problem, replace
the PU/CU board
or encrypted HDD.
Service Call
257: Error
An unexcepted error
Does error reoccur?
occurred during
initializing HDD.
HDD Error cause
information was
displayed after an
error number.
Power Off/On.
Yes Format the HDD
again. If it does not
solve the problem,
replace the HDD.
Power Off/On
901: Error, 902:
Error
Short or open in
Internal thermistor
detected.
Service Call
254: Error
Is internal thermistor
cable setting proper?
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On
903: Error, 904:
Error
Power Off/On
911: Error, 912:
Error
Abnormal
temperature
detected by Internal
thermistor
(high-temp or low
temp.)
The Geared Motor
Error at the Optional
Tray.
911:Tray2
912 Tray3
45487001TH Rev.1
Is internal thermistor
cable setting proper?
Does error reoccur?
Is the indicated tray
installed properly?
Does error reoccur?
No
Connect cable set
properly again.
Yes Turn power ON
again.
Yes Replace the
internal thermistor.
No
Connect cable set
properly again.
Yes Turn power ON
again.
Yes Replace the
internal thermistor
and leave aside for
30 minutes.
Then turn power
ON again.
No
Install the optional
tray properly.
Yes Turn power ON
again.
Yes Replace the
Geared Motor of
indicated tray.
Panel display
Power Off/On
918: Error
Cause
An error was
detected with the
Duplex Fan Motor.
Check details
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur
after power restoration?
Result
Solution
Power Off/On.
Yes Check if the FAN
is connected
properly.
Yes Replace the FAN.
Power Off/On
923: Error
An error was
detected with the
image drum motor
by overload.
Check if the image
drum is installed
properly.
Yes Replace the image
Does error reoccur
drum unit.
after power restoration?
Does error reoccur
Yes Replace the ID
motor.
after power restoration?
Power Off/On
928: Error
An error was
detected the Fuser
Motor rotation by
overload.
Check if the
fuser is installed
properly.
Yes Replace the fuser.
Does error reoccur
after power restoration?
Does error reoccur
Yes Replace the fuser
after power restoration?
motor.
Power Off/On
933: Error
Tray2 CPU Clock
Frequency Error
Yes Replace the unit.
Does error reoccur
after power restoration?
Does error reoccur
Yes Replace the PU/
after power restoration?
CU board.
Power Off/On
934: Error
Tray3 CPU Clock
Frequency Error
Yes Replace the unit.
Does error reoccur
after power restoration?
Does error reoccur
Yes Replace the PU/
after power restoration?
CU board.
Power Off/On
935: Error
Tray4 CPU Clock
Frequency Error
Yes Replace the unit.
Does error reoccur
after power restoration?
Yes Replace the PU/
Does error reoccur
CU board.
after power restoration?
Power Off/On
941: Error
A watch dog timer
error was detected.
Power Off/On
942: Error
An undefined
interruption was
detected.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
6-28 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Panel display
Cause
Check details
Power Off/On
943: Error
PU CPU ran away
out of control due to
noise etc.
Power Off/On
944: Error
An error was
detected with
accessing the Dcon
circuit.
Power Off/On
945: Error
SDRAM access at
power on failed.
Power Off/On
947: Error
EMF Missing Error
Power Off/On
948: Error
Detect hopping
motor rotate error
Error occurred when
hopping motor error
detected
Service Call
982: Error
Unsupport Tray
Error
Are many trays beyond
the specification
installed?
Service Call
984: Error
Black Tag Version
Mismatch
Service Call
999: Error
The PU/CU firmware
has a problem with
its compatibility.
Power off/on
F0C: Error
PC:nnnnnnnn
LR:nnnnnnnn
FR:nnnnnnnn
An error was
detected of the CU
program.
Solution
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error reoccur?
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Does error reoccur?
Does error reoccur?
45487001TH Rev.1
Result
Power Off/On.
Panel display
Power off/on
FFF: Error
PC:nnnnnnnn
LR:nnnnnnnn
FR:nnnnnnnn
Cause
Check details
An error was
detected of the CU
program.
Does error reoccur?
Result
Solution
After turn power
OFF, check
connections
between CU board
and PU board.
Then turn power
ON again.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
Note) Service call errors, Error: 169, Error: 171, Error: 172, Error: 173, Error: 903 and
Error: 904, can occur when the printer temperature is under 0C; therefore, if
the printer temperature is low, turn on the printer after the printer temperature
has risen enough.
Yes Use trays as many
as specified.
Power Off/On.
Yes Replace the toner
cartridge, the
image drum or
Print Cartridge.
After turn power
OFF, check
connections
between CU board
and PU board.
Then turn power
ON again.
Yes Replace the PU/
CU board.
6-29 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2 Preparation for troubleshooting
(1) LCD display error............................................................................................6-31
(1-1)
(1-2)
(1-3)
LCD does not display anything..........................................................6-31
Error message related to the control panel.......................................6-32
RAM checking or Initializing remains displayed. ..........................6-32
(2) Abnormal operations of the printer after the power is turned on.....................6-32
(2-1)
(2-2)
(2-3)
(2-4)
Any operation does not start at all.....................................................6-32
Abnormal sound is heard..................................................................6-33
Bad odors are generated...................................................................6-34
Rise-up time is slow...........................................................................6-34
(3) Paper feed jam (Error 391: 1st Tray)................................................................6-48
(3-1)
(3-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on. (1st tray).......6-48
Jam occurs immediately after the paper feed is started. (1st tray)....6-48
(4) Feed jam (Error 380).......................................................................................6-49
(4-1)
(4-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.......................6-49
Jam occurs immediately after the paper feed is started....................6-50
(5) Paper feed jam (Error 390: MP Tray)...............................................................6-51
(5-1)
(5-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
(Multipurpose tray)............................................................................6-51
Jam occurs immediately after paper feed is started.
(Multipurpose tray)............................................................................6-51
(6) Paper running jam (Error 381)........................................................................6-52
(6-1)
(6-2)
(6-3)
(6-4)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.......................6-52
Jam occurs immediately after a paper is taken into printer...............6-53
Jam occurs in the middle of paper running path................................6-54
Jam occurs immediately after paper has reached the fuser..............6-54
(7) Paper unloading jam (Error 382).....................................................................6-55
(7-1)
(7-2)
(7-3)
Paper unloading jam occurs immediately
after the power is turned on. .............................................................6-55
Paper unloading jam occurs after a paper is taken into printer..........6-55
Paper unloading jam occurs in the middle of paper running path. ...6-56
(8) Two-sided printing jam (Errors 370, 371, 372, 373 and 383) .........................6-56
(8-1)
(8-2)
Two-sided printing jam occurs immediately
after the power is turned on...............................................................6-56
Two-sided printing jam occurs during taking in the paper
into Duplex unit..................................................................................6-56
45487001TH Rev.1
(8-3)
(8-4)
Two-sided printing jam occurs during transporting paper inside the
Duplex unit.........................................................................................6-57
Paper is not supplied from the Duplex unit to the regist roller...........6-57
(9) Paper size error (Errors 400 and 401)............................................................6-57
(9-1)
Jam occurs when paper end is located near the IN1 sensor.............6-57
(10) Fuser unit error (Errors 167 to 177)................................................................6-58
(10-1) Error occurs immediately after the power is turned on......................6-58
(10-2) Error occurs approx. 1 minute after the power is turned on...............6-58
(11) Motor fan error (Errors 122, 127, 128, 918 and 051)......................................6-59
(11-1) The low voltage power supply fan does not rotate immediately after the
power is turned on.............................................................................6-59
(11-2) Duplex fan does not rotate during the Duplex printing.......................6-59
(11-3) All fans of the printer do not rotate....................................................6-60
(12) Print speed is slow. (Performance is low.).......................................................6-60
(12-1) Print speed decreases.......................................................................6-60
(13) Option unit cannot be recognized...................................................................6-60
(13-1) Option try unit cannot be recognized................................................6-60
(14) LED head cannot be recognized. (Errors 134)................................................6-61
(14-1) Errors 131 to 134 (LED HEAD Missing)............................................6-61
(15) Toner cartridge cannot be recognized. (Errors 543).......................................6-62
(15-1) Error caused by the consumable items.............................................6-62
(15-2) Error caused by the toner sensor......................................................6-62
(15-3) Error caused by the defective mechanism........................................6-63
(16) Fuse cut error (Errors 155) ............................................................................6-63
(16-1) Fuse cut error....................................................................................6-63
(17) Humidity sensor error (Error 123)...................................................................6-64
(17-1)
Humidity sensor error.......................................................................6-64
(18) Wiring diagram................................................................................................6-65
Note! When replacing the PU/CU board, load the EEPROM chip contents of the
old board first, and copy them to the new board upon completion of the
replacement. (Refer to section 4.4.1 Precautions when replacing the engine
control board.)
6-30 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2 (1) LCD display error
Check item
after the name of the respective connectors,
to
Memo For the numbers from
refer to section 6.5.2 (18) Wiring diagram.
(1-1)
LCD does not display anything.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(1-1-1) Check the fuse.
Fuse of the PU/CU
board
Check if F3 or F5 has blown out.
Replace the PU/
CU board.
(1-1-2) Check the system connection
Check if the cable from the low voltage power
supply to the POWER connector
of the PU/
CU board is normally connected or not.
Check if the connector is connected only in
the half-way or not, and check if the connector
is inserted in slanted angle or not.
Re-connect the
cable normally.
Cable assembly
connecting the
low voltage power
supply unit and the
PU/CU board
Check if the cable is half-open circuit.
Check if sheath of the cable has not peeled
off or not.
Check if the cable assembly is defective such
as internal wires are disconnected or not.
Replace the
cable with the
normal cable.
Connection
between the PU/
CU board and the
control panel board
Check if the 10-conductor FFC is connected
to the OPE connector
of the PU/CU board
normally or not.
Check if the 10-conductor FFC is connected
to the OPE connector
of the control panel
board normally or not.
Check if the connector is connected in the
halfway only or not, and check if the connector
is inserted in a slanted angle or not.
Re-connect the
cable normally.
Check if the cable has open circuit or not with
VOM. Check if sheath of the cable has not
peeled off or not by visual inspection.
Replace the
FFC with the
normal FFC.
Connection
between the low
voltage power
supply unit and the
PU/CU board
FFC connecting the
PU/CU board and
the control panel
board
45487001TH Rev.1
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(1-1-3) Check the peripherals of the power supplies
AC power that is
supplied to the printer
Check the supplied voltage of the AC power
source.
Supply the AC
power.
5V power that is
supplied to the PU/
CU board
Check for 5V power supply at pin-1, -3 and
-4 of the POWER connector
of the PU/CU
board.
Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
3.3V power that is
supplied to the PU/
CU board
Check for 3.3V power supply at pin-22 of the
POWER connector
of the of the PU/CU
board.
Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
3.3V power that
is supplied to the
control panel board
Check for 3.3V power supply at pin-4 of the
OPE connector
of the control panel board.
Replace the PU/
CU board.
(1-1-4) Check that power supply circuit has no short-circuit.
5V power and 24V
power that are
supplied to the PU/
CU board.
Check that power supply circuit has no shortcircuit at the POWER connector
of the PU/
CU board. The follow voltage must appear
respectively.
pin-11, -13, -14, -15, -16: 24V
pin-1, -2, -3, -4: 5V
pin-5, -6, -7, -8, -9: 0VL
pin-17, -18, -19, -20, -21: 0VP
pin-10: 5Vs
If any voltage does not appear and shortcircuit is detected, locate the source of the
short-circuit as follows:
Disconnect the cables that are connected to
the PU/CU board one cable after another until
location of the short-circuit is found out.
Replace the part
causing shortcircuit.
(1-1-5) LSI operation check
I/F signal supplied
from the PU/CU
board to the control
panel board.
Check if signals are output to the OPE
connector
of the PU/CU board.
Pin-5: Send data (Sending data from the PU/
CU board)
Replace the PU/
CU board.
I/F signal supplied
from the PU/CU
board to the control
panel board.
Check if signals are output to the OPE
connector
of the PU/CU board.
Pin-7: Send data (Sending data from the PU/
CU board)
If it is normal, signals are output always.
Replace the
control panel
board.
6-31 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(1-2)
6.5.2.(2) Abnormal operations of the printer after the power is turned on
Error message related to the control panel
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(1-3)
Check the error contents by referring to the
Error Message List.
Follow the
instruction.
RAM checking or Initializing remains displayed.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be
taken at NG
(1-3-1) Control panel displays freezes.
Control panel
display
45487001TH Rev.1
Any operation does not start at all.
Check item
(1-2-1) Error message
Error message
(2-1)
The control panel keeps displaying RAM
checking or Initializing.
Replace the PU/
CU board.
If the problem
remains
unsolved after
an optional RAM
or SD memory
card is removed,
replace the PU/
CU board.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-1-1) Check the peripherals of the power supplies
AC power that is
supplied to the printer
Check the supplied voltage of the AC power
source.
Supply the AC
power.
5V power and 24V
power that are
supplied to the PU/
CU board
Check the power supply voltages at the
POWER connector
of the PU/CU board.
pin-11, -13, -14, -15, -16: 24V
pin-1, -2, -3, -4: 5V
pin-5, -6, -7, -8, -9: 0VL
pin-17, -18, -19, -20, -21: 0VP
pin-10: 5Vs
Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit.
(2-1-2) Power switch LED check
Power switch LED
Check if the LED light stays off.
Replace one of
the following: low
voltage power
supply unit, PU/
CU board, power
SW board, the
cable between
the low voltage
power supply
unit and the PU/
CU board, the
cable between
PU/CU board or
the power SW
board.
When blinking:
Replace one of
the following: low
voltage power
supply unit, PU/
CU board, power
SW board, or the
cable between
the low voltage
power supply
unit and the PU/
CU board board.
6-32 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-1-3) Check the system connection
Connection
condition of the
control panel
(2-2)
Check contents of (1-1).
The printer will not start operation until the
control panel is detected and its operation is
started.
Follow the
contents of (11).
Check item
Check work
Operating
conditions of the
respective motors
Check if operations of the respective motors
are normal or not by using the self-diagnostic
mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
"Buzz buzz" sound is generated when an
error occurs.
Replace the
corresponding
consumable
item.
If any attempt
of using new
part as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Installation
condition of each
consumable item
Check by visual inspection if the respective
consumable items are installed in their normal
positions in which gears of the consumable
items engage accurately or not.
Replace an
appropriate
mechanical part
as required, or
adjust or repair
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-2-1) Check loss of synchronization of motor (Driver error)
Condition of the
motor cable
Operating
conditions of the
respective motors
Check for normal wiring conditions of the
respective motors.
Perform the visual check and measure
resistance at open circuit with VOM as follows.
Remove the motor cable at the board end.
Measure resistance between the respective
pins of the removed cable and FG with VOM.
Replace the
motor cable.
Re-connect the
cable for normal
conditions.
Check if operations of the respective motors
are normal or not by using the self-diagnostic
mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
"Buzzer" sound when an error occurs.
Replace the PU/
CU board.
(2-2-2) Check loss of synchronization of motor (Abnormal load of the consumable item)
Operating
conditions of the
respective motors
45487001TH Rev.1
Check if operations of the respective motors
are normal or not by using the self-diagnostic
mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
"Buzzer" sound when an error occurs.
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-2-3) Check the jumping phenomena of gear tooth. (Abnormal load of the consumable
item)
Abnormal sound is heard.
Check item
Check work
(2-2-4) Check the wiring conditions of cables
Wiring conditions
of the cables in
the vicinity of the
respective cooling
fans
Check
if the cable contacts with the fan blade
because wiring conditions of the cables near
fan is poor or not.
"Clap, clap" sound is generated when an error
occurs.
Correct the
wiring conditions
of the cable.
Replace the
corresponding
consumable
item.
If any attempt
of using new
part as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
6-33 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(2-3)
Bad odors are generated.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-3-1) Locating the exact position of generating bad odor
Fuser unit
Remove the fuser unit and check the odor.
Implement
section (2-3-2).
Low voltage power
supply unit
Remove the low voltage power supply unit
and check the odor.
Replace the low
voltage power
supply unit
(2-3-2) Check conditions of the fuser unit
Life count of fuser
unit
Check the life count of the fuser unit by using
the self-diagnostic mode.
The fuser close
to the new fuser
unit smells some
odors.
Check that no
foreign material
exists in fuser unit.
Check that no foreign materials such as paper
are stuck inside of the fuser unit.
Remove the
foreign material.
(2-4)
Rise-up time is slow.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-4-1) Check the fuser unit
Heater
Confirm
the voltage specification on the label
on the rear of the fuser unit.
Replace the
fuser unit.
(2-4-2) Check the optional parts Note!
Add-on memory
Install the optional parts (add-on memory)
again and re-check the operations.
Replace the
optional part.
SD memory casd
Install the optional part (SD memory card)
again and recheck the operations.
Replace the
optional part.
Note! If any troubles such as printer does not start up normally occurs, remove the CU
options (RAM, SD memory card) and check if the trouble symptom changes or not.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-34 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(3) Error code numbers and locations of paper jams
When paper jams occur or paper remains in the printer, Paper Jam, or Paper Remain is
displayed on the operation panel.
By pressing the Help button, a method to remove the paper is displayed, so remove the
paper in the printer according to the remedy displayed.
In addition, refer to paper removal methods described on the reference pages given in the
table on the right.
<HELP> button
<ATTENTION> indicator
Message on the display screen
Display Screen when the <HELP> button is pressed
Error Code
Scroll display upward
Scroll display downward
45487001TH Rev.1
Message on the display screen
Error code(s)
Open Cassette
Paper Jam
%Tray%
391, 392, 393,
394
Open Cassette
Paper Remain
%Tray%
631, 632, 633,
634
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
372
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
380
Check Paper
Paper Multi Feed
%Tray%
401
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
390
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Front Cover
637
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
381
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
638
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
382, 383, 385
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
639, 640
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Jam
370, 371, 373
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Remain
641, 642
Reference page
page 6-37
page 6-38
page 6-40
page 6-41
page 6-42
page 6-44
page 6-46
6-35 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Outline drawing of jam locations
J1
(370:Duplex
Reversal)
J7
(382:Exit)
EXIT sensor
J6
(381:TRANSPORT)
J5(380:FEED)
J12(400:PAPER
J9
SIZE ERROR) (390:MISS FEED AT
FRONTFEEDER)
WR2 sensor
DUP-IN sensor
J8
(383:Duplex Entry)
J2
(371:Duplex Input)
J3
(372:Missfeed
DUP-F sensor
at Duplex)
IN2 sensor
IN1 sensor
J10
(391:Tray1)
HOP sensor
J11
(392:Tray2)
2nd-IN
SENSOR
J14
(393:Tray3)
3rd-IN
SENSOR
4th-IN
SENSOR
45487001TH Rev.1
6-36 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
391, 392, 393, 394
Open Cassette
Paper Jam
%Tray%
634, 632, 633, 634
Open Cassette
Paper Remain
%Tray%
(3) Place the paper tray back into the printer.
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
Tray1 is applied here as an example.
(1) Pull the indicated paper tray out from the printer.
(4) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
Paper tray
Front cover open lever
(2) Remove the jammed paper.
(5) Close the front cover.
Memo Keep it in mind that the error message is not cleared unless the front cover is
opened and closed following removal of the jammed paper.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-37 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
372
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
If you cannot find the jammed paper
1. Open the rear cover by pulling the lock lever on the back side of the printer
toward you.
Lock lever
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Rear cover
Front cover
2. Check for jammed paper inside the printer. If jammed paper remains, remove
it.
Front cover open lever
(2) Remove the jammed paper gently.
If an edge of jammed paper can be seen
3. Close the rear cover.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-38 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
5. Pull out the duplex unit by holding the grips on its both sides.
5. Return the duplex unit to the printer.
Grip (blue)
Grip (blue)
(3) Close the front cover.
Duplex unit
6. Open the upper cover of the duplex unit and check for jammed paper in the
duplex unit. If jammed paper remains, pull it out. Then, close the upper cover.
Upper cover
45487001TH Rev.1
6-39 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
380
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
401
Check Paper
Paper Multi Feed
%Tray%
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
Front cover open lever
(2) Remove the jammed paper gently.
(3) Close the front cover.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-40 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
390
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Front Cover
637
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Front Cover
(3) Remove the jammed paper gently.
If an edge of jammed paper can be seen
If you cannot find the jammed paper
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) If there is any paper on the MP Tray, open the paper set cover and take it out.
Paper set cover
(2) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
Front cover open lever
(3) Close the front cover.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-41 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
381
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
368
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
(3) Remove ID unit and place it on new paper etc. on a flat surface.
ID unit
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
(4) Cover the removed ID unit with paper so that it will not exposed to light.
Front cover open lever
(2) Open the top cover.
Top cover
45487001TH Rev.1
(5) Pull out the jammed paper gently toward the inside of the printer (in the direction
of the arrow) if an edge of jammed paper can be seen on the back side of the
registration guide.
6-42 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6) Open the registration guide in the direction of the arrow.
Registration guide
(7) Pull out the jammed paper gently in the direction of the arrow if an edge of jammed
paper can be seen on the front side.
(9) Pull out the jammed paper gently while tilting the release levers (6) on the fuser unit
forward if an edge of jammed paper cannot be seen.
If an edge of jammed paper still remains inside the unit, pull out the jammed paper
gently toward the inside of the printer.
(10) Return the ID unit into the printer carefully.
(8) Pull out the jammed paper gently in the direction of the arrow if an edge of jammed
paper can be seen on the back side.
(11) Close the top cover.
(12) Close the front cover.
Note! Cannot close the front cover securely if the top cover is not closed.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-43 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
382, 383, 385
Open Cover
Paper Jam
Top Cover
639, 640
Open Cover
Paper Remain
Top Cover
(3) Remove ID unit and place it on new paper etc. on a flat surface.
ID unit
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
(4) Cover the removed ID unit with paper so that it will not exposed to light.
Front cover open lever
(2) Open the top cover.
Top cover
(5) Remove the jammed paper remaining inside of the unit.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-44 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6) Hold the fuser unit handle and lift the fuser unit out of the printer.
(8) Hold the fuser unit handle and return the fuser unit into its original position.
Possible to get burned.
Fuser unit
Do not touch the fuser unit. It is hot.
Fuser unit
(9) Return the ID unit into the printer carefully.
(7) Tilt the release lever on the fuser unit forward, and be sure to pull out the jammed
paper forward gently.
Release lever
(10) Close the top cover.
(11) Close the front cover.
Note! Cannot close the front cover securely if the top cover is not closed.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-45 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
370, 371, 373
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Jam
641, 642
Check Duplex Unit
Paper Remain
(3) Close the rear cover.
Remedy when the above messages are displayed
(1) Open the rear cover by pulling the lock lever on the back side of the printer toward
you.
Lock lever
Rear cover
(4) Insert your finger into the recess on the right side of the printer and pull the front
cover open lever to open the front cover forward.
Front cover
(2) Check for jammed paper inside the printer. If jammed paper remains, remove it.
Front cover open lever
45487001TH Rev.1
6-46 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Pull out the duplex unit by holding the grips on its both sides.
(7) Return the duplex unit to the printer.
Grip (blue)
Grip (blue)
(8) Close the front cover.
Duplex unit
(6) Open the upper cover of the duplex unit and check for jammed paper in the duplex
unit. If jammed paper remains, pull it out. Then, close the upper cover.
Upper cover
45487001TH Rev.1
6-47 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(3) Paper feed jam (Error 391: 1st Tray).
(3-1)
(3-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on. (1st tray)
Check item
Check work
Check item
Actions to be taken
at NG
(3-1-1) Check condition of the paper running path
aper running path
P
of the front unit
Open the front cover check if paper is not
jammed in the paper running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(3-1-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
heck the sensor
C
levers of the paper
entrance sensor
1 and the paper
entrance sensor 2.
Check
if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever
with the good
sensor lever.
(3-1-3) Check condition of electrical parts
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the Maintenance Menu
SWITCH SCAN function.
Replace either
the PU/CU
board or the
front sensor
board (HSC2 PCB) or
connection
cable.
Check output signal
level of the paper
entrance sensor
1 and that of the
paper entrance
sensor 2.
Check for the following signals at the FSNS
connector
of the PU/CU board.
Pin-4: Paper entrance sensor 1
Pin-3: Paper entrance sensor 2
Confirm that the above signal levels change
when the sensor lever is operated.
Replace the
front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the power
voltages supplied
to the front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the 5V power at the FSNS connector
of the front sensor board (HSC-2 PCB).
Pin-1: 5V power supply
Pin-5: 0VL
Replace the
connection
cable.
45487001TH Rev.1
Jam occurs immediately after the paper feed is started. (1st tray)
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(3-2-1) Check condition of the paper running path
Paper running path
of the front unit
Check if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(3-2-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
Check the sensor
levers of the paper
entrance sensor
1 and the paper
entrance sensor 2.
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor with the
good sensor
lever.
Check the feed
roller, pickup roller
and the retard roller
assembly of the
tray.
Check if any foreign materials such as paper
dust on the surface of the feed roller or of the
pickup roller or not.
Remove the
foreign material.
Check if the feed roller or the pickup roller has
worn out or not.
Replace the
feed roller, the
pickup roller and
the retard roller
assembly of the
tray.
(3-2-3) Motor operation check
Paper feed motor
Confirm that the paper feed motor works
normally by using the Motor & Clutch Test of
the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace the PU/
CU board or
the paper feed
motor.
6-48 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(3-2-4) Check the system connection
Paper feed motor
drive cable
Check
the connection condition of the cable.
Check if the connector is connected in the halfway only or not, and check if the connector
is inserted in a slanted angle or not. Check
also that cables are assembled without any
abnormality.
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
Check to make sure that the paper feed clutch
or registration clutch works normally by using
the Motor & Clutch Test of the self-diagnostic
mode.
Open the front cover so that the rollers can be
seen to check.
Replace the
PU/CU board,
or replace the
paper feed
solenoid.
(3-2-6) Check the system connection
Clutch cable for
paper feed
Check
the connection condition of the cable.
Check if the connector is connected in
the half-way only or not, and check if the
connector is inserted in a slanted angle or not.
Check also that cables are assembled without
any abnormality.
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
Cable for paper
feed clutch
Check that any cable is not pinched during
assembling of the printer.
Remove the HOPCLT connector of the PU/CU
board and check the following at the cable side.
Short circuit between pin-1 FG
Remove the HOPCLT connector of the PU/
CU board and check that approx. 240 can be
measured between pin-1 and pin-2.
Replace the
clutch and
assembly it
again correctly.
45487001TH Rev.1
(4-1)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(4-1-1) Check condition of the paper running path
aper running path
P
of the front unit
Open the front cover check if paper is not
jammed in the paper running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(4-1-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
(3-2-5) Clutch operation check
Paper feed clutch,
registration clutch
6.5.2.(4) Feed jam (Error 380)
heck the sensor
C
levers of the paper
entrance sensor 1,
that of the paper
entrance sensor
2 and that of the
WR2 sensor.
Check
if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor with the
good sensor
lever.
(4-1-3) Check condition of electrical parts
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the Maintenance Menu
SWITCH SCAN function.
Replace either
the PU/CU
board or the
front sensor
board (HSC2 PCB) or
connection
cable.
Check the output
signal levels of the
paper entrance
sensor 1, that of
the paper entrance
sensor 2 and that
of the WR2 sensor.
Check
for the following signals at the FSNS
connector
of the PU/CU board.
Pin-4: Paper entrance sensor 1
Pin-3: Paper entrance sensor 2
WR2SNS connector
Pin-2:WR2 sensor
Confirm that the above signal levels change
when the sensor lever is operated.
Replace the
front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the power
voltages supplied
to the front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the 5V power at the FSNS connector
of the front sensor board (HSC-2 PCB).
Pin-1: 5V power supply
Pin-5: 0VL
Replace the
connection
cable.
6-49 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(4-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the paper feed is started.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(4-2-1) Check condition of the paper running path
Paper running path
of the front unit
Check if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(4-2-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
Check the sensor
levers of the paper
entrance sensor 1,
that of the paper
entrance sensor
2 and that of the
WR2 sensor.
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check the connection condition of the cable.
Check if the connector is connected in
the half-way only or not, and check if the
connector is inserted in a slanted angle or not.
Check also that cables are assembled without
any abnormality.
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
Check item
(4-2-4) Check the system connection
Paper feed motor
drive cable
Replace the
sensor with the
good sensor
lever.
(4-2-3) Motor operation check
Paper feed motor
45487001TH Rev.1
Confirm that the paper feed motor works
normally by using the Motor & Clutch Test of
the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace the
PU/CU board,
or replace the
paper feed
motor.
6-50 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(5) Paper feed jam (Error 390: MP Tray)
(5-1)
(5-2)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on. (Multipurpose tray)
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(5-1-1) Check condition of the paper running path
aper running path
P
of the multipurpose
tray
Check
if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(5-1-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
heck the sensor
C
levers of the paper
entrance sensor
2 and the WR2
sensor.
Check
if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor with the
good sensor
lever.
(5-1-3) Check condition of electrical parts
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN
function of the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace either
the PU/CU
board or the
front sensor
board (HSC2 PCB) or
connection
cable.
Check the sensor
output signal
level of the paper
entrance sensor
2 and the WR
sensor.
Check for the following signals at the FSNS
connector of the PU/CU board.
Pin-3: Paper entrance sensor 2
WR2SNS connector
Pin-2: WR2 sensor
Confirm that the above signal levels change
when the sensor lever is operated.
Replace the
front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the power
voltages supplied
to the front sensor
board (HSC-2
PCB)
Check the 5V power at the FSNS connector
of the front sensor board (HSC-2 PCB).
Pin-1: 5V power supply
Pin-5: 0VL
Replace the
connection
cable.
45487001TH Rev.1
Jam occurs immediately after paper feed is started. (Multipurpose tray)
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(5-2-1) Check condition of the paper running path
aper running path
P
of the multipurpose
tray
Check
if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
Sheet Receive of
the multipurpose
tray
Confirm
that the Sheet Receive has moved
up normally.
Confirm that the support spindle and spring of
the Sheet Receive have been installed in the
specified positions normally.
Correct installation of the above
parts so that the
Sheet Receive
moves up to the
specified position normally.
(5-2-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
Check the sensor
levers of the paper
entrance sensor
2 and the WR2
sensor.
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor with the
good sensor
lever.
Front cover
Confirm that the locks in the right and left of
the front cover are locked normally.
Replace the
font cover
assembly
Check the feed
roller, the pickup
roller, and the
retard roller.
Check if any foreign materials such as paper
dust on the surface of the feed roller or of the
pickup roller or not.
Remove the
foreign material.
Check if the feed roller has worn out or not.
Replace the
feed roller.
(5-2-3) Motor operation check
Paper feed motor
Confirm that the paper feed motor works
normally by using the Motor & Clutch Test of
the self-diagnostic mode.
MPT clutch
Carry out Motor & Clutch Test to check if the
MPT clutch works normally.
Replace the PU/
CU board, or
replace the paper
feed motor.
6-51 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(5-2-4) Check the system connection
Paper feed motor
drive cable
Check
the connection condition of the cable.
Check if the connector is connected in
the half-way only or not, and check if the
connector is inserted in a slanted angle or
not.
Check also that cables are assembled without
any abnormality.
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
6.5.2.(6) Paper running jam (Error 381)
(6-1)
Jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-1-1) Check condition of the running path.
Paper running path
of the front unit
Check
if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(6-1-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
Check the sensor
lever of the WR2
sensor.
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever
with the good
sensor lever.
(6-1-3) Check condition of electrical parts
45487001TH Rev.1
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN
function of the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace either
the PU/CU
board or the
WR2 sensor
or connection
cable.
Check the sensor
lever of the WR2
sensor.
Check for the following signals at the
WR2SNS connector
of the PU/CU board.
Pin-2: WR2 sensor
Confirm that the above signal levels change
when the sensor lever is operated.
Replace the
WR2 sensor
Check the power
voltages supplied
to the WR2 sensor
Check
the 5V power at the WR2SNS
connector of the WR2 sensor .
Pin-1: 5V power supply
Pin-3: 0VL
Replace the
connection
cable.
6-52 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6-2)
Jam occurs immediately after a paper is taken into printer.
Check item
Check work
Check item
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-2-1) Check condition of the paper running path
aper running path
P
on the belt.
Remove
the ID unit and check if paper is
jammed or not in the paper running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
(6-2-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
heck the sensor
C
lever of the WR
sensor.
Check
if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever
with the good
sensor lever.
(6-2-3) Motor operation check
ID motor
45487001TH Rev.1
Confirm
that the paper feed motor and ID
motor work normally by using the Motor &
Clutch Test of the self-diagnostic mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board,
or replace
ID motor, or
replace the ID
unit .
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-2-4) Check the system connection
Paper feed motor
drive cable, ID
motor drive cable,
fuser motor drive
cable
Check the connection condition of the cables.
PU/CU board DCHOP connector, DCID
connector , DCHEAT connector , HOPCLT
connector.
Check if the connector is connected in the
halfway only or not, and check if the connector
is inserted in a slanted angle or not.
Check also that cables are assembled without
any abnormality.
Normalize the
connection
condition.
Replace the
cable with the
normal cable.
Hopping clutch
drive cable
Remove the HOPCLT connector
of the PU/
CU board and check the following at the cable
side.
Short circuit between pin-1 FG
Short circuit between pin-2 FG
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
Hopping clutch
PU/CU board HOPCLT connector
Between pin-1 - pin-2: Approx. 240
Replace the
hopping clutch
6-53 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(6-3)
Jam occurs in the middle of paper running path.
Check item
Check work
(6-4)
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-3-1) Motor operation check
ID motor
Confirm
that the paper feed motor and ID
motor work normally by using the Motor &
Clutch Test of the self-diagnostic mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
Jam occurs immediately after paper has reached the fuser.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-4-1) Motor operation check
Replace the
PU/CU board,
or replace
ID motor, or
replace the ID
unit .
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Fuser motor
Confirm
that the fuser motor works normally
by using the Motor & Clutch Test of the selfdiagnostic mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
Replace the PU/
CU board.
Replace the
fuser motor.
Replace the
fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(6-4-2) Temperature control
Detected
temperatures of the
fuser
Check temperatures detected at the fuser in
the self-diagnostic mode. Has abnormally low
(lower than the room temperature) or high
(250C) temperature been detected?
Replace the
fuser unit or
PU/CU board.
If any attempt
of using new
fuser unit as
a trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the system
maintenance
menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(6-4-3) Check the installation condition of fuser unit
Fuser unit
45487001TH Rev.1
Check that the fuser unit is installed normally.
(Is it pushed in down to the bottom-most
point?)
Install the fuser
unit correctly in
a printer.
6-54 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(7) Paper unloading jam (Error 382)
(7-1)
(7-2)
Paper unloading jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(7-1-1) Check condition of the paper running path
Paper running
path of the paper
unloading unit
Check if paper is jammed or not in the paper
running path.
Remove the
jammed paper.
Paper unloading jam occurs after a paper is taken into printer.
Check item
Check work
(7-2-1) Check condition of the paper running path
Face Up Stacker
Cover
Confirm
that it is either fully opened or fully
closed
Eliminate any
in-between
condition of the
cover between
the fully open
position and fully
closed position.
Duplex pull-in gate
Confirm that the Duplex pull-in gate works
normally by using the Motor & Clutch Test of
the self-diagnostic mode.
Is it set to the paper unloading side normally?
Replace the
Duplex pullin gate or the
Duplex solenoid
Rear panel
Check
that the installation condition of the
rear panel hampers smooth movement of a
paper in the paper running path, or not.
Remove the
rear panel and
re-install it.
Paper running path
of unloading unit
Check that any mechanical load does not
exist that hampers the smooth movement of
paper in the paper running path of the paper
unloading unit, by the visual inspection.
Check if the paper unloading motor becomes
difficult to rotate or not.
Correct the
portion that
becomes
mechanical
load.
(7-1-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
heck the sensor
C
lever of the paper
exit sensor.
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever with
the good sensor
lever.
(7-1-3) Check condition of electrical parts
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN function
of the self-diagnostic mode.
R
eplace the PU/
CU board or
EXIT sensor or
its cable or its
connection cable.
Check the output
signal level of the
EXIT sensor.
Check for the following signals at the RSNS of
the PU/CU board.
Pin-2: EXIT sensor
Confirm that the above signal levels change
when the sensor lever is operated.
Replace the
EXIT sensor.
Check the power
voltages supplied to
the EXIT sensor.
Check the 5V power voltage at the Relay cable
of the EXIT SNS.
Pin-1: 5V power supply
Pin-3: 0VL
Replace the
connection
cable.
(7-2-2) Check condition of the mechanical parts
ensor lever of the
S
paper exit sensor
Check
if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever
with the good
sensor lever.
(7-2-3) Motor operation check
(7-1-4) Check the system connection
Fuser motor
ignal cable for
S
relay cable, EXIT
sensor cable
Check that FFC is normally inserted at the
RSNS of the PU/CU board .
Check that the relay board and the EXIT
sensor are normally connected.
Normalize the
connection
condition.
Signal cable for
relay board, EXIT
sensor cable
Confirm that the cables are not pinched,
sheathes are not peeled off, and they are
assembled normally.
Replace the
connecting cable
and normalize
the assembled
condition.
45487001TH Rev.1
Actions to be taken
at NG
Confirm
that the fuser motor works normally
by using the Motor & Clutch Test of the selfdiagnostic mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or fuser motor
or fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
6-55 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(7-2-4) Check the system connection
Fuser motor drive
cable
(7-3)
Replace the
cable with the
good cable
that normalizes
the connection
condition.
Check the connection condition of the cables.
Visually check the PU/CU board DCHEAT
connector
for half-way connection, slanted
angle insertion, and abnormal cord assembly.
Also check the connector connected with the
fuser motor in the same manner.
6.5.2.(8) Two-sided printing jam (Errors 370, 371, 372, 373 and 383)
(8-1)
Two-sided printing jam occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(8-1-1) Check condition of electrical parts
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal.
Paper unloading jam occurs in the middle of paper running path.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
C
onfirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN function
of the self-diagnostic mode.
For all sensors except the Dup-IN sensor, check the
detection condition of the respective sensor in the
two status: One is the status in which paper remains
inside the Duplex unit. The other is the status in
which paper is removed from the Duplex unit.
eplace the
R
PU/CU board
or the defective
sensor or
connection
cable.
(7-3-1) Motor operation check
Fuser motor
Confirm that the fuser motor works normally
by using the Motor & Clutch Test of the selfdiagnostic mode.
Check if any load exists or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or fuser motor
or fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(8-2)
Two-sided printing jam occurs during taking in the paper into Duplex unit.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(8-2-1) Solenoid operation check
Duplex clutch
Confirm that the duplex clutch works normally
by using the Motor & Clutch Test of the selfdiagnostic mode.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or clutch.
Separator solenoid
(Paper unloading/
DUP paper taking
in switching gate
located immediately
after the fuser unit)
Check visually movement of the gate by using
the Motor & Clutch Test of the self-diagnostic
mode.
Check if movement is unsmooth or not, if
amount of open/close is abnormal or not.
Replace the
separator
solenoid.
(8-2-2) Sensor lever operation check
45487001TH Rev.1
Dup-IN sensor
lever
Remove the duplex unit. Touch the DupIN sensor lever to check if its movement is
unsmooth or not.
Replace the
Dup-IN sensor
lever
DUP-IN sensor
Check the sensitivity of each sensor in the two
conditions: one is the status in which paper
remains in the duplex unit, and the other is the
status in which no paper remains in the duplex unit.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN
function of the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or replace the
defective sensor
or connection
cable.
6-56 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(8-2-3) Check condition of the paper running path
Paper inverting
transport path
(8-3)
Check that any foreign materials such as
paper chip or blue do not exist that hampers
the smooth movement of paper in the paper
inverting transport path.
Remove
the foreign
material.
6.5.2.(9) Paper size error (Errors 400 and 401)
(9-1)
Jam occurs when paper end is located near the IN1 sensor.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Multifeed of papers
Open the front cover and check if multifeed of
papers occurs or not.
If multi-feed
occurs again
after the
jammed paper
is removed,
replace the
retard roller of
the tray in use.
Check item
(9-1-1) Check paper feed condition
Two-sided printing jam occurs during transporting paper inside the Duplex unit.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(8-3-1) Sensor lever operation check
Dup-F sensor lever
Remove the Duplex unit and check movement
of the Dup-F sensor lever.
Replace the
Dup-F sensor
lever.
Paper size
Does the paper size specified for print match
the paper size of paper stuck in the tray.
Change the
specified paper
size or size of
paper inside
the tray.
Check the sensitivity of each sensor in the
two conditions: one is the status in which
paper remains in the duplex unit, and the
other is the status in which no paper remains
in the duplex unit.
Confirm that the sensor signals are normally
detected by using the SWITCH SCAN
function of the self-diagnostic mode.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or replace
the defective
sensor or
connection
cable.
Paper entrance
sensor 1, paper
entrance sensor 2
Check if shape and movement of the sensor
levers have any abnormality or not.
Replace the
sensor lever
with the good
sensor lever.
(8-3-2) Sensor check
Check the detection
condition of the
sensor signal
(8-4)
Paper is not supplied from the Duplex unit to the regist roller.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(8-4-1) Clutch operation check
Duplex clutch
45487001TH Rev.1
Confirm that the Duplex clutch works normally
by using the Motor & Clutch Test of the selfdiagnostic mode.Confirm it by listening to the
sound.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or clutch.
6-57 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(10) Fuser unit error (Errors 167 to 177)
(10-2) Error occurs approx. 1 minute after the power is turned on.
(10-1) Error occurs immediately after the power is turned on.
Check item
Check work
(10-1-1) Thermistor is defective
Upper thermistor,
lower thermistor,
side thermistor,
heater thermistor
Installed condition
of fuser unit.
Check item
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check the respective thermistors if they are
shorted or opened internally.
Check the resistance value at the connector
pins in the bottom of the fuser unit.
(Refer to section 9.1 Resistance value (fuser
unit).)
Check if the fuser nit is pressed in until the
connector in the bottom of the fuser unit is
surely connected.
Replace the
fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Re-set the fuser
unit.
Note! Service calls 171: Error and 175: Error can occur when the printer temperature
is below 0C. Turn on the power again after the printer temperature has
increased.
45487001TH Rev.1
Actions to be taken
at NG
(10-2-1) Temperature increase of fuser unit
Thermostat, heater
Note)
Check work
Heater of the fuser unit is controlled of its
temperature. Check if the fuser unit gets hot
or not by touching it with hands.
If the fuser unit temperature does not increase
and remains cold, check that the resistance
between pin-1 and pin-4 and between pin-3
and pin-2 is about 1 to 3, between pin-2 and
pin-4 is about 4 to 7 respectively. (Refer to
section 9.1 Resistance value (fuser unit).)
Replace the
fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(10-2-2) Temperature increase of fuser unit
Installation position
of the Lower
thermistor
The Lower thermister must be installed while
contacting with the fuser unit. Check if the
lower thermister is installed in the far position
from the specified position or not causing
detection of the lower temperature than the
actual temperature of fuser unit.
R
eplace the
fuser unit.
If any attempt of
using new fuser
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
6-58 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(10-2-3) AC power input for the fuse
6.5.2.(11) Motor fan error (Errors 122, 127, 128, 918)
(11-1) The low voltage power supply fan does not rotate immediately after the power is
turned on.
AC power voltage
from the low
voltage power
supply
Check
if the AC voltage for heater is normally
supplied or not.
Power supply CN03 connector , between
pin-1 and pin-4, and between pin-2 and pin-3.
eplace the low
R
voltage power
supply.
Heater ON signal
that is output
from PU to the
low voltage power
supply
Check that the heater ON signal goes active
at the warming up timing, or not.
"L" active while ON.
Power connector of the PU/CU board,
between pin-24 and pin-26.
Replace the
PU/CU board.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(11-1-1) Cable connection condition and wiring condition
Cable connection
condition and
wiring condition
of the low voltage
power supply fan
and those of the
fuser fan
Check if the connectors are connected
normally or not.
Check if extra length of the cables does not
touch the fan blade or not.
Correct the
connection
condition of
the connectors.
Correct the
cable wiring
route. Replace
the fan.
(11-2) Rear fan does not rotate during the Duplex printing.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(11-1-2) Cable connection condition and wiring condition
45487001TH Rev.1
Cable connection
condition and
wiring condition of
the Duplex fan
Check if the connectors are connected
normally or not.
Check if extra length of the cables does not
touch the fan blade or not.
orrect the
C
connection
condition of
the connectors.
Correct the
cable wiring
route. Replace
the fan.
24V power supplied
to the fan
Check if the fuse F1 of the PU/CU board has
blown out or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board.
6-59 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(13) Option Unit cannot be recognized.
(11-3) All fans of the printer do not rotate.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check item
(11-3-1) 24V power supply
PU/CU board fuses
F1, F503
Check
if the fuses F1 is not open-circuit or
not.
Replace the
PU/CU board.
24V power that is
supplied to the PU/
CU board.
Check the power supply voltages at the
POWER connector of the PU/CU board.
The follow voltage must appear respectively.
Pins-17, -18, -19, -20, -21: 0VP
Pins-11, -13, -14, -15, -16: 24V
Replace the low
voltage power
supply.
6.5.2.(12) Print speed is slow. (Performance is low.)
(12-1) Print speed decreases.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(12-1-2) Media Weight setting
Media Weight that
is specified for the
print
45487001TH Rev.1
(13-1) Option try unit cannot be recognized.
Check if the wrong Media Weight has been
specified or not.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(13-2-1) Option try board
Option try unit
Check if the option try unit specification is
being used or not.
Replace the
option tray unit.
(13-1-2) Check the system connection
Check the system
connection from the
PU/CU board to the
option tray board
(GOH-12 PCB).
Check that the cable between the PU/CU
board option connector to the option tray
board is normally connected.
Correct the
connections.
Square connector
connecting the
option tray unit to
the printer.
Check if any foreign material exists in the
connecting portion of the square connector.
Remove
the foreign
material.
Square connector
connecting the
option tray unit to
the printer.
Is the terminals of the square connector
damaged?
Replace the
connector.
(13-2-3) Check the control signals.
Correct the
Media Weight.
Check the control
signal that is output
from the PU/CU
board to the option
tray board (GOH-12
PCB).
Check the control signal that is output from
the PU board option connector .
Pin-8: OPTCNT2 (PU 2nd)
Pin-9: TXD (PU 2nd)
Pin-10: RXD (2nd PU)
Pin-9: Replace
the PU/CU
board.
Pin-10: Replace
the option tray
board.
6-60 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(14) LED head cannot be recognized. (Errors 134)
(14-1) Errors 134 (LED HEAD Missing)
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(14-1-1) Check the system connection
Connecting
condition at the
PU/CU board
connector and at
the head connector.
Check the connecting condition of the FFC by
the visual inspection.
Correct the
connection
to the normal
connecting
condition.
Head FFC
Remove the head FFC from the printer. Check
if any open-circuit or peeling-off of sheath has
occurred or not throughout the cable.
Replace the
head FFC or
the PU/CU
board.
Conduction of the
fuse on the PU/CU
board.
Check that 5V is measured at the ends of the
capacitors CP15 and also check if
the fuse F17 or F13 is open-circuited.
Replace the
PU/CU board.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-61 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Note! Toner sensor operation check method using the SWITCH SCAN function of
the self-diagnostic mode.
6.5.2.(15) Toner cartridge cannot be recognized. (Errors 543)
(15-1) Error caused by the consumable items.
Check item
Check work
(1) How to check operation of the toner sensor at the printer side.
Actions to be taken
at NG
1. Status change of the toner sensor can be checked from the control panel using
the self-diagnostic mode. First, switch the display to the control panel display.
For the method of switching the display to the control panel display, refer to
section 6.3.2.3 Switch Scan Test
(15-1-1) Consumable items installation condition
ID unit and toner
cartridge
Check that the ID unit is installed in the
normal position. Check that the lock lever of
the toner cartridge is locked.
Correct the
installation to
the normal
installation
condition.
2. Remove the ID unit and the toner cartridge (TC) from a printer. There is a
window inside a printer opposing the ID side when viewed from the front of a
printer. The toner sensor is located inside the window.
3. Place a white paper 3 mm away from the sensor window. The white paper
should be placed in the manner of opposing the toner sensor.
4. When light is reflected by a white paper so that incident light falls on the toner
sensor, the control panel display shows "L". When the paper is moved so that
any light is not reflected by the paper so that the incident light does not reach
the toner sensor, "H" is displayed on the control panel.
(15-2) Error caused by the toner sensor
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
5. If the control panel display toggles between "H" <-> "L" as a paper is flipped
in front of the toner sensor, it indicates that the toner sensor and the related
system of the printer are working normally.
(15-2-1) Toner sensor condition
Toner sensor
Toner sensor
Is the receptor of the toner sensor stained?
Confirm that the toner sensor works normally
by using the SWITCH SCAN function of the
self-diagnostic mode.
Place a white paper in front of the toner
sensor, and check if the SCAN state changes
or not.
Wipe off the
stain from the
toner sensor.
Replace the
toner sensor
board or the
FFC between
the toner
sensor board
and the PU/CU
board.
Action to be taken at NG
Clean surface of the toner sensor to remove the stains due to residual toner
and paper dust.
Check the connection condition of the FFC cable between the PU/CU board
and the toner sensor board (97T).
Perform the operation check again. If the situation has not bee improved and
remains unchanged, replace the PU/CU board or the toner sensor board (97T).
(2) How to check operation of the toner sensor at the toner cartridge (TC) side
1. To the position where the toner sensor is confirmed to be operating normally
in the printer itself by the above paragraph (1), install the TC and the ID unit to
check operations by observing display on the control panel.
Action to be taken at NG
Check operation condition of the respective ID motors by using the Motor &
Clutch Test of the self-diagnostic mode.
Clean surface of the silver reflector plate on the side of ID to remove stains. (Stain
due to toner or paper dust)
45487001TH Rev.1
6-62 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(16) Fuse cut error (Errors 155)
(15-3) Error caused by the defective mechanism
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check
if a heavy mechanical load is being
applied to the ID unit due to breakage of the
waster toner belt, or not.
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check if the HEAT connector
of the PU/CU
board is connected halfway, or inserted at an
angle.
Check if cable has open-circuit or its sheath is
peeled off.
Connect the
cable normally.
Alternately,
replace the
cable.
Upon completion of the system connection
check, turn off the power once and back on.
The check if the error occurs or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board.
Check item
(15-3-1) Mechanical load applied to the ID unit
ID unit
(16-1) Fuse cut error
Replace the ID
unit.
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(16-1-1) Check the system connection
Cable connecting
the PU/CU board
(16-1-2) Fuse cut circuit
PU/CU board
(15-3-2) Motor operating condition
ID motor
45487001TH Rev.1
Confirm that the respective ID motors work
normally or not by using the Motor & Clutch
Test of the self-diagnostic mode.
Check if any extra load exists or not.
Replace the
PU/CU board
or the ID motor.
6-63 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(17) Humidity sensor error (Error 123)
(17-1)
Humidity sensor error
Check work
Connection
between the PU/
CU board and the
control panel board
Check if the 10-conductor FFC is connected
to the OPE connector
of the PU/CU board
properly.
Check if the 10-conductor FFC is connected
to the CN501 connector
of the control
panel board properly.
Check the connectors for half-way connection
or angled connection.
Re-connect the
cable normally.
FFC connecting the
PU/CU board and
the control panel
board
Check for open-circuit with VOM.
Visually check that the sheath for peeling.
Replace the
FFC with a
normal FFC.
FFC connecting the
PU/CU board and
the environment
sensor board
Check for open-circuit with VOM.
Visually check that the sheath for peeling.
Replace the
FFC with a
normal FFC.
(17-1-1) Check the system connection
45487001TH Rev.1
Actions to be taken
at NG
Is the environment condition changed sharply
from a low temperature environment to a high
environment condition within a short time?
(Example is such a case that a printer is
moved from storage condition of a cold area
in winter to an office environment.)
Leave a printer
for around one
hour in the new
environment
to get used
to the new
environment.
After that, turn
on the power
again.
Before turn
on the power,
touch the metal
panel of the
controller panel
and the metal
plate inside a
printer to feel
temperature
increase
inside a printer
with human
hands. After
confirmation
that the printer
temperature has
increased close
to the room
temperature,
turn on the
power again.
(17-1-2) Environment condition
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check item
Check work
Check item
Sharp change
of environment
condition
6-64 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.2.(18) Wiring diagram
Relay
Toner
sensor
PCB
ID
motor
HOP
motor
Relay
TRAY1
HOP
clutch
Relay
Relay
DC ID
TONER
ID FAN
STKL
TAG
HEAD0
LAN
USB1
PU/CU PCB
DUPSNS
WR2
MPT PE sensor
WR2 sensor
HOP
motor
WLPOW
MPTPE
MPT
clutch
DUP
CENT
ID thermistor
WLAN
module
TAG PCB(TC)
Relay
MPTCLT ID TEMP
FSNS
Relay
REGCLT HOPCLT
PSIZE
OPTION
Optoin Tray Boad
Boad-GOH12
REG
clutch
PEHOP
DC HOP
IN2 sensor
STKFL
sensor
LAN2
IN1 sensor
Relay
To lower tray
HOP
clutch
HEAD
USB3
TRAY1
PE
sensor
TAG PCB(ID)
HVOLT
OPE
IL
PWSW
SATA IF
SATA POW
POWFAN
POWER
DC HEAT
LAN
IN
sensor
USB
(Device)
Paper
size
sensor
PE
sensor
HOP
sensor
Front
USB
Centro PCB
Centronics
DUPF sensor
Relay
DUP IN sensor
RSNS
Front sensor
PCB
TRAY1
HOP
sensor
ID2 FAN
Dup
motor
REG2
clutch
REG1
clutch
To printer main unit
or upper tray
Dup
solenoid
Dup
clutch
EXIT sensor
Rear switch
HEAT
FU sensor
TRAY1 paper size switch
PCQ PCB
2nd Tray unit
3rd Tray unit
High-voltage
power supply
PCB
Control panel
PCB
Enviromental sensor
PCB
45487001TH Rev.1
Rear FAN
Fuser
motor
Cover
switch1
(IL)
Fuser unit
Power
FAN
4th Tray unit
Fuser FAN
HDD
Power SW
PCB
Low-voltage
power supply
PCB
AC inlet
6-65 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3 Troubleshooting the abnormal images
(1) Color has faded-out and blurred entirely. (Refer to Figure 6-2 A.)..................6-67
(1-1)
Color are faded-out and blurred. .......................................................6-67
(2) Stain on white print. (Refer to Figure 6-2 B.)...................................................6-68
(2-1)
(2-2)
Stain on white print (Partial stain).....................................................6-68
Stain on white print (overall stain).....................................................6-68
(3) White print (Refer to Figure 6-2 C.).................................................................6-69
(3-1)
White print over entire page..............................................................6-69
(4) Black banding/black streaking in vertical direction..........................................6-70
(4-1)
(4-2)
Thin vertical line (with color) (Refer to Figure 6-2 D.)........................6-70
Thin vertical line (without color) (Refer to Figure 6-2 F.)...................6-70
A Overall faded-out
Blurred
B Stain on white print
C Entirely white
E Cyclic abnormality
F White banding/
(5) Periodic abnormalities (Refer to Figure 6-2 E.)...............................................6-70
(5-1)
Periodic abnormality occurs in vertical direction...............................6-70
(6) Solid black printing..........................................................................................6-71
(6-1)
Solid black printing over the whole page...........................................6-71
D Black banding/
black streaking
in vertical direction
Note! To replace a PU/CU board, data of the EEPROM chip on the old PU/CU board
must be read beforehand copied to the new board after replacement.
45487001TH Rev.1
white streaking
in vertical direction
Figure 6-2
6-66 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3.(1) Color has faded-out and blurred entirely. (Refer to Figure 6-2 A.)
(1-1)
Color are faded-out and blurred.
Check item
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(1-1-5) ID unit installation condition
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(1-1-1) Toner
Remaining amount
of toner
Check
if the message "Prepare toner
replacement." or "Replace the toner." appears
or not.
Replace toner
cartridge with
new one.
Tape attached to
the toner cartridge
opening slot
Check to see that the tape attached to the
toner cartridge opening slot has been peeled
off.
ove the toner
M
cartridge lever to
CLOSE position
and remove tape
from opening
slot.
Lens of the LED
head
Check
if surface of the lens of the LED head
is stained or not by toner and paper dust.
Clean the lens
with soft tissue
paper.
Mounting condition
of LED head
Check that the LED head is mounted on the
LED head holder correctly. Check that the
right and left tension springs are normally
installed.
Correct
for normal
condition.
Check to see that the print media which is
used for printing is not a specially thick media
Use the normal
paper.
ID unit DOWN
position (Defective
transfer)
ove the ID unit in and out with hand to
M
confirm that any abnormal mechanical load
does not exist, and the ID unit can be moved
down to the DOWN position normally. If a
piece of paper is inserted in between drum
and belt, if top end of the paper can enter
easily, it is NG (No Good).
Check the
U-shaped
groove of the
side plate for
any abnormality.
If repair is found
impossible,
replace the
equipment.
(1-1-2) LED head
(1-1-3) Print media
Media type
(1-1-4) High voltage terminal
ID unit terminal
45487001TH Rev.1
ICheck that the high voltage terminal of the ID
unit is contacting with the Contact Assembly
normally by visual inspection. (Refer to Figure
6-3.)
I Replace the ID
unit or correct
the high voltage
terminal.
If any attempt
of using new ID
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
6-67 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3.(2) Stain on white print. (Refer to Figure 6-2 B.)
(2-1)
Stain on white print (Partial stain)
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check if the offset toner of the previous
printing is left adhered on the fuser unit or not,
by visual inspection.
R
epeat blind
printing using
unwanted media
until offset toner
is created on
print media.
Alternately
replace the
fuser unit. If any
attempt of using
new fuser unit as
a trial is going to
be made, be sure
to use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Check item
(2-1-2) Fuser unit
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(2-1-1) ID unit
Exposure of drum
to light
Is the drum left in a circumstance in which
drum surface is exposed to direct light for a
long time?
Replace the ID
unit.
If any attempt
of using new ID
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Leakage of toner
Does toner leak out from either ID unit or from
toner cartridge?
Replace the
ID unit or toner
cartridge.
If any attempt
of using new ID
unit as a trial
is going to be
made, be sure to
use the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Offset toner of the
fuser unit
(2-2)
Stain on white print (overall stain)
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check
to see that the print media which is
used for printing is not a specially thin media.
Use the normal
paper.
Check item
(2-2-1) Print media
Type of print media
(2-2-2) High voltage terminal
ID unit terminal
45487001TH Rev.1
Check that the high voltage terminal of the ID
unit is contacting with the Contact Assembly
normally by visual inspection. (Refer to Figure
6-3.)
Replace the ID
unit or correct
the high voltage
terminal.
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
6-68 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3.(3) White print (Refer to Figure 6-2 C.)
(3-1)
White print over entire page
Check item
Check work
Confirm that sufficient amount of toner
remains inside the ID unit.
Replace the
toner cartridge.
(3-1-2) Exposure condition to light
LED head
Confirm that the LED head is positioned in the
normal position where the LED head opposes
again the drum when the cover is closed.
Check that no obstacle exists in front of the
LED head, that hampers light emission from
the illuminating surface of the LED head.
Correct the
installation
condition of the
LED head.
Connecting
condition of the
LED head
Check that the LED head is normally
connected.
Replace the
LED head.
Drum shaft
Check that the drum shaft keeps contacting
with the right and left side plates normally.
Replace the ID
unit.
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
F15, F16, fuse on
the PU/CU board
Measure resistance of F15, F16.
1 or less: Normal
Higher than 1: NG
Replace the
PU/CU board
45487001TH Rev.1
Actions to be taken
at NG
Check that the high voltage terminal of the ID
unit is contacting with the Contact Assembly
normally by visual inspection. (Refer to Figure
6-3.)
Replace the ID
unit or correct
the high voltage
terminal.
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(3-1-3) High voltage terminal
Actions to be taken
at NG
(3-1-1) Toner condition
Remaining amount
of toner
Check work
Check item
ID unit terminal
6-69 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3.(4) Black banding/black streaking in vertical direction
6.5.3.(5) Periodic abnormalities (Refer to Figure 6-2 E.)
(4-1)
(5-1)
Thin vertical line (with color) (Refer to Figure 6-2 D.)
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(4-1-1) ID unit condition
Filming of the ID
unit
(4-2)
Replace toner
cartridge with
new one. If
replacement
does not solve
the problem,
replace the
ID unit. If any
attempt of using
new ID unit as
a trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Thin vertical line (without color) (Refer to Figure 6-2 F.)
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(4-2-1) LED head condition
LED head
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(5-1-1) Cycle
Is print attempted without toner?
Check item
Periodic abnormality occurs in vertical direction
any foreign material attached on the light
Is
emitting surface of the cell fox lens of the LED
head?
Remove
the foreign
material.
Image drum
Check that the cycle is 94.3 mm.
Developing roller
Check that the cycle is 39.7 mm.
Toner feed roller
Check that the cycle is 66.6 mm or 72.8 mm.
Charge roller
Check that the cycle is 37.7 mm.
Fuser belt
Check that the cycle is 94.3 mm.
Heat roller
Check that the cycle is 90.3 mm.
Transfer roller
Check that the cycle is 51.5 mm.
Replace the ID
unit
Replace the ID
unit
Replace the ID
unit
Replace the ID
unit
Replace the
fuser unit.
Replace the
fuser unit.
Replace the
Transfer Roller.
If any attempt
of using new
consumable
item as a trial
is going to
be made, be
sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
(4-2-2) Condition of paper running path
Paper running path
45487001TH Rev.1
Check that any burr that may scatter the unfused toner on the paper running path does
not exist.
Remove the
burr.
6-70 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.3.(6) Solid black printing.
(6-1)
Solid black printing over the whole page
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
(6-1-1) High voltage contacting condition
CH terminal
Check that the terminal coming from the
printer body contacts with the high voltage
terminal that is located on the left side of the
ID unit when viewed from the top by visual
inspection.
Replace the
terminal of
printer side.
CH terminal
Check that the high voltage terminal keeps
the normal contacting condition on the high
voltage board. Open the left cover and remove
the high voltage board. Then, check that
the terminal is not installed in the abnormal
installation condition.
Correct the
installation
condition of
the terminal
to the normal
condition.
ID unit terminal
Check that the high voltage terminal of the ID
unit is contacting with the Contact Assembly
normally by visual inspection. (Refer to Figure
6-3.)
Replace the ID
unit or replace
the high voltage
board or correct
the high voltage
terminal.
If any attempt
of using new
ID unit as a
trial is going
to be made,
be sure to use
the System
Maintenance
Menu FUSE
KEEP MODE.
Charge roller
Ground
Developer roller
Toner feed roller
Figure 6-3
(6-1-2) High voltage output condition
CH output
45487001TH Rev.1
If high voltage probe is available as a
maintenance tool, open the left cover, and
check the CH output with the high voltage
probe from the soldering side of the high
voltage board. (The high voltage probe is not
an ordinary maintenance tool.)
Replace the
high voltage
board.
6-71 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.4 Image Quality Issues
symptom
Offset Ghost(Positive Ghost)
Paper feeding direction
Smear around solid black image
Cause
Remedy
If the interval of image is about 90 Use supported paper.
mm,the paper is unsuitable.
The paper is too dry.
Use paper stored in proper
temperature and humidity
conditions.
Low humidity condition.
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
select "ON" for [Quiet Mode].
If smear around solid black image, Press the button and select
transfer bias is low.
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
change to "+3" the value for [Paper
Black setting].
The paper is too dry.
Use supported paper.
The paper is high impedance.
Paper feeding direction
Broken line
The paper is rough.
Paper feeding direction
Faded print image (GAZURE)
symptom
If the faded print image on both
side of 100% solid black image,
The paper smoothness is high.
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Tray Configuration] >
the paper try configuration you
are using, and then select "heavy"
or more value for [Media Weight].
Use supported paper.
Front and back of paper inside
out
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Tray Configuration] >
the paper try configuration you
are using, and then select "heavy"
or more value for [Media Weight].
Use lower smoothness paper.
Some dots in white area
Paper feeding direction
Ghost
Cause
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
change the value(+2 or +3) for [BG
Setting].
vertical long solid line
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
change the value(+2 or +3) for
[SMR Setting].
The paper is too moist.
The paper is too thin.
Set envelope mode of fuser
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Tray Configuration],
and then select "Ultra heavy 1" for
[Media Weight].
When half tone density is high.
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
change the value(+2 or +3) for [BG
Setting].
B
Paper feeding direction
Wrinkle
Paper feeding direction
Graininess
Paper feeding direction
Faded print at low density half tone image When half tone density is low
When print in the low
BBBBBBBB
temperature(LL)
Paper feeding direction
Remedy
After added new toner
When print in the high
temperature(HH,HL)
When print at the low speed
Press the button and select
[menus] > [Print Adjust], and then
change the value(+1 or +2) for
[Darkness].
BBBBBBBB
Paper feeding direction
45487001TH Rev.1
6-72 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5 Network troubleshooting
6.5.5.1 Connection error occurs with the Web browser
(1) Print cannot be activated from Utilities
If the printer setting page cannot be displayed by the web browser "https://<printer IP
address>", check the followings.
Check item
Check work
Actions to be taken
at NG
Establish connection by "https://<printer IP address>.
(1) Check the LINK lamp
Check if the LINK
lamp (green) is
illuminating or not.
Check if the HUB and a printer are connected
normally. (Check that the network cable is
connected normally.)
Re-connect the
network cable
normally.
Confirm that the straight network cable is
being used.
Replace the
cable with the
straight cable.
Make an attempt to change connection of the
network cable to other port of a HUB.
Try to change the
HUB.
(2) Check the network information
Check if the
network information
can be printed
normally or not.
Operate the panel (Print Printer Information
Network Print) and print out the network
information.
Re-write the
NIC-F/W by
using Utilities.
(3) Check contents of the network information.
Confirm the IP
address, SUB net
mask and gateway
address.
Confirm the IP address, SUB net mask and
gateway address that are printed on the
network information.
Set the IP
address, SUB net
mask and gateway
address normally.
1) If the printer setting page is displayed, the followings are probable.
Take an appropriate measure by referring to the following items.
* Certificate is not created yet. (Or failed to create certificate.)
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.1 Is the certificate created?".
* Certificate has been created but the SSL/TLS setting is turned off.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.2 Is the SSL/TLS setting set to [ON]?".
2) If the printer setting page is not displayed, the followings are probable.
* Version number of the browser is old.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.3 Check version number of the Web browser".
* Encryption strength has been set to Strong.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.4 Check encryption strength of a printer".
* The key exchange system of a printer is not supported by the browser.
(Compatibility problem)
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.5 Check the key exchange type of the certificate".
(4) Check if communication is possible or not through network
Confirm if the Ping
command can be
sent or not from a
PC to a printer.
Confirm if correct reply is returned from a
printer to a PC when the PC sends the Ping
to a printer.
Set the IP
address, SUB net
mask and gateway
address normally.
Check the setting items of the OKI LPR
Utilities.
Set the OKI LPR
Utilities setting
items correctly.
(5) Check the Utilities.
Check setting of the
OKI LPR Utilities.
(6) Check the following from an OS standard port
Confirm the
standard LPR port
of the WINDOWS
standard (NT, 2000,
XP).
45487001TH Rev.1
Set the standard LPR port of the WINDOWS
standard (NT, 2000, XP), and confirm if
printing can be performed or not.
Set the standard
LPR port of the
WINDOWS
standard (NT,
2000, XP) correctly.
6-73 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.1.1 Is the certificate created?
6.5.5.1.2 Is the SSL/TLS setting set to [ON]?
Log-on in as the administrator, and select "Admin Setup" "Network Setup" "Security"
"SSL/TLS".
Log-on in as the administrator, and select "Admin Setup" "Network Setup" "Security"
"SSL/TLS".
If the following screen is displayed, certificate of the printer is not created yet. (The same
screen is displayed when failed to create certificate.)
If the following screen is displayed, certificate has already been created, but the SSL/TLS
setting is turned [OFF].
Solution: Create certificate by referring to the Users Manual (Advanced edition).
Solution : Set the SSL/TLS setting to [ON].
Before creating certificate (default state)
45487001TH Rev.1
6-74 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.1.3 Check version number of the Web browser
Check version number of the Web browser in use.
How to check version number.
For Internet Explorer
Launch the browser and select "HELP"
"Version information".
Recommended version is Internet Explorer 5.5 and higher.
Solution : Install the newest web browser. Alternately, install the high encryption
pack.
If any version that is older than the recommended version is used,
communication can become possible sometimes when the encryption
strength is set to "Weak". If the encryption strength is set to "Weak",
security level lowers. To change the encryption strength, refer to
section "6.5.4.1.4 Confirm encryption strength of a printer".
45487001TH Rev.1
6-75 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.1.4 Confirm encryption strength of a printer
Solution: Set the encryption strength to "Weak".
Version display of the browser that is confirmed by section "6.5.5.1.3 Check version
number of the Web browser" has description on encryption strength of the browser. The
browser in which the encryption strength is not set to 128 bits, the browser cannot establish
communication with the printer in which the encryption strength is not set to "Standard".
How to change encryption strength with Telnet
Either, upgrade the browser until it supports 128 bits (high encryption) or set the printer
encryption strength to "Weak".
Note! Telnet cannot be used if it remains in the default setting. To change the
encryption strength, Telnet must be set to Enable.
Select the command prompt (DOS prompt) and enter "Telnet <printer IP address>", and
press Return.
Establish connected using administrator user name and password
Select the menus in this order: [4: Security Config]
[5: Cipher (SSL/TLS)]
[2:
Cipher Strength]. Then, change the cipher strength as desired (1: Strong, 2: Standard, 3:
Weak).
45487001TH Rev.1
6-76 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.2 Print operation is not possible
6.5.5.2.1 Check OS (Operating System)
If print operation is not possible by using the encrypted IPP printer, check the followings.
The IPP print (encryption) function is supported by Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows
2003 Server and Windows Vista only.
Establish connection by "https://<printer IP address>.
1) If the printer setting page is displayed, the followings are probable.
Take an appropriate measure by referring to the following items.
* Certificate is not created yet. (Or failed to create certificate.)
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.1 Is the certificate created?".
* Certificate has been created but the SSL/TLS setting is turned off.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.2 Is the SSL/TLS setting set to [ON]?".
2) If the printer setting page is not displayed, the followings are probable.
Take an appropriate measure by referring to the following items.
* Version number of the browser is old.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.3 Check version number of the Web browser".
* Encryption strength has been set to Strong.
Refer to section "6.5.5.1.4 Check encryption strength of a printer".
* The key exchange system of a printer is not supported by the browser.
(Compatibility problem)
* The OS does not support the IPP (encrypted) printing.
Refer to section "6.5.5.2.1 Check OS (Operating System)".
* IPP (encrypted) printer is not created yet.
Refer to section "6.5.5.2.2 Is the Printer created?".
* IPP setup of the Printer is not Enabled.
Refer to section "6.5.5.2.3 Is the IPP setting set to Enabled?".
45487001TH Rev.1
It is not supported by other operating systems.
6.5.5.2.2 Is the Printer created?
Printer may not be created normally.
To use the IPP print (encryption) function, the Printer must have been created by setting port
to URL" HYPERLINK "https://<" https://< printer IP address>/ipp" when creating the Printer.
For more details of Printer creation method, refer to the Users Manual (Advanced edition).
6.5.5.2.3 Is the IPP setup Enabled?
The IPP setup may not be set to Enable.
As the default setting of printer, IPP has been set to Disable.
To use the IPP print (encryption) function, the IPP setup must have been set to Enable.
For the method of changing the IPP setup, refer to the Users Manual (Advanced edition).
6-77 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.3 Cannot create Certificate
6.5.5.4 Installation of Certificate is not possible
When Certificate cannot be created, the following causes are probable. Take an appropriate
measure by referring to the following items.
When installation of Certificate fails, the following causes are probable.
* Required input items are not fully entered
Refer to section "6.5.5.3.1 Required input items are not fully entered".
* The printer is printing.
Refer to section "6.5.5.3.2 The printer is printing".
6.5.5.3.1 Required input items are not fully entered
Unless all of the required input items are fully entered, Certificate cannot be created.
When creating Certificate, entry into the items of Common Name, Organization, Locality, State/
Province, Country/Region is the must item. (Entry into Organizational Unit can be omitted.)
Solution : Enter the appropriate value into all of the required input items, and execute
creation of Certificate.
For more details of the input items, refer to the Users Manual (Advanced
edition).
6.5.5.3.2 The printer is printing.
Certificate cannot be created while printing is in progress. (Print operation has priority.)
Solution : Create Certificate when all other operations are complete.
During creation of self-sign certification, during creation of CSR for Certificate
of certifying authority, and during installation of Certificate, the printer must not
perform any other operations (such as printing) until the operation is complete
(creation of self-sign certification is complete, creation of CSR is complete,
and installation of Certificate is complete).
45487001TH Rev.1
Take an appropriate measure by referring to the following items.
* User has changed the IP address of a printer to other IP address than the "IP
address during creation of CSR".
Refer to section "6.5.5.4.1 IP address of the printer has been changed".
* "Network card is initialized" while user is applying issuance of certification to
certifying authority (i.e., in the state of Waiting for Installation of Certificate).
Refer to section "6.5.5.4.2 "Network card is initialized".
* "Deletion of CSR" was executed while user is applying issuance of certification
to certifying authority (i.e., in the state of Waiting for Installation of Certificate).
Refer to section "6.5.5.4.3 "Deletion of CSR" is executed.
* Intermediate Certificate is installed.
Refer to section "6.5.5.4.4 "Installation of intermediate Certificate" is desired.
6.5.5.4.1 User has changed the IP address of a printer
If IP address of a printer is changed to other IP address than the "IP address during creation
of CSR", error is issued and installation of Certificate become impossible.
If the changed setup is only the "IP address of printer", error will not be issued if the IP
address is returned to the original address.
Solution : Return the IP address of printer back to the "IP address during creation of
CSR", and then install Certificate.
Note! Do not change any setup of printer while creation of Certificate of certifying
authority is in progress (during the period starting from creation of CSR up
until installation of Certificate). If changed, the already issued Certificates
become invalid necessitating re-setup starting from the very beginning. If
printer setup is changed after Certificate is obtained, the "Security warning" is
displayed on the web browser.
If IP address of printer is changed, the Certificate becomes invalid. In the
case of Certificate of certifying authority requiring some charge for issuance,
another charge may be required for creating Certificate once again. For
details, contact certifying authority.)
6-78 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.4.2 "Network card is initialized"
If network card is initialized (to default setup) while creation of Certificate of certifying
authority is in progress (during the period starting from creation of CSR up until installation of
Certificate), the setup information of the Certificate is deleted. If information is deleted once,
the information cannot be recovered by any means. (Even when the same information as
before is entered, the same Certificate cannot be created.)
6. Troubleshooting procedure
2. Press the "General" tab of the displayed Certificate information, and press "Install
Certificate" button.
Solution : Repeat all the steps from the very beginning. (Certificate under application is
already invalid.)
6.5.5.4.3 "CSR is deleted"
If CSR is deleted (if Certificate is deleted) while creation of Certificate of certifying authority
is in progress (during the period starting from creation of CSR up until installation of
Certificate), the setup information of the Certificate is deleted. If information is deleted once,
the information cannot be recovered by any means. (Even when the same information as
before is entered, the same Certificate cannot be created.)
Solution : Repeat all the steps from the very beginning. (Certificate under application is
already invalid.)
6.5.5.4.4 Installation of intermediate Certificate is desired
3. The "Certificate Import Wizard" is displayed. Install Certificate in accordance with
the displayed procedure. Select "Automatically select the certificate store based on
the types of certificate". Then, the Certificate will be installed automatically.
Some certification authorities use the procedure of installing the SSL server Certificate (printer
Certificate) and the intermediate Certificate into printer as the same time.
However, printer of this model supports installation of only a single Certificate, intermediate
Certificate cannot be installed in printer. Be sure to install the SSL server Certificate in printer.
When installation of intermediate Certificate is required, install the intermediate Certificate
not in printer, but in client PC (browser).
For the method of installing the intermediate Certificate in client PC (browser), refer to the
following.
Installing the intermediate Certificate (or CA certificate) in client PC (browser).
[Procedure]
1. Double-click the intermediate Certificate (or CA certificate) that is issued by
certifying authority, on a client PC to display the intermediate Certificate (or CA
certificate).
ex.) For an example, the intermediate Certificate of Comodo has the text (PEM)
format: ComodoJapanCA.Crt, and the binary format: ComodoJapanCA.cer.
Either one of these formats can be opened. (Same result can be obtained.)
Open either ComodoJapanCA.crt or ComodoJapanCA.cer.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-79 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.5 Other questions
Other probable questionnaires are described below.
6.5.5.5.1 Time required for creation of Certificate
It takes several ten seconds for creation of Certificate.
6.5.5.5.2 Communication time when the encryption function is enabled
A time longer than the ordinary communication time is required for communication when the
encryption function is used.
6.5.5.5.3 Can encrypted printing be performed by any printer other than IPP?
Answer : Any printer other than IPP cannot encrypt printing.
Only the IPP printing can encrypt printing.
6.5.5.5.6 The error message "The security certificate was issued by a company
you have not chosen to trust. View the certificate to determine whether
you want to trust the certifying authority" is displayed.
If this error is indicated, it means that the certificate which is installed in a printer is self-sign
certificate.
In the case of self-sign certificate, error (security warning) will not be displayed if the self-sign
certificate of printer is installed in the client PC.
In the case of certificate of certifying authority, error (security warning) will not be displayed if
the CA certificate of certifying authority is installed in the client PC.
Solution : Install certificate in the client PC (browser).
[Procedure]
1. Click the "View Certificate" button on the error (security warning) screen.
2. Press the "General" tab of the displayed Certificate information, and press "Install
Certificate" button.
6.5.5.5.4 What will happen if SSL/TLS is turned OFF after Certificate has been
created (or installed)?
Answer : Certificate will be kept saved as it is.
If SSL/TLS is turned ON again, the Certificate becomes usable.
6.5.5.5.5 Want to change the port number
Answer : The port number during the SSL/TLS communication is fixed to 443.
It cannot be changed.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-80 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
3. The "Certificate Import Wizard" is displayed. Install Certificate in accordance with
the displayed procedure. Select "Automatically select the certificate store based on
the types of certificate". Then, the Certificate will be installed automatically.
6. Troubleshooting procedure
6.5.5.5.7 The error message "Name of security certificate is invalid or does not
match the site name" is displayed.
It means that the IP address of printer is different from the IP address that is described on
certificate, or from the IP address when the certificate is created.
Solution : Return the IP address of printer back to the address when self-sign certificate
is created, or to the address when CSR is created.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-81 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.5.6 Restrictions when using Internet Explore 7
Several restrictions are imposed when using Internet Explore 7. This is because security
restriction became more severe in IE7.
Solution : When "Continue browsing this site (not recommended)" is clicked on the
warning screen, the web page will be displayed.
However, it has no effect on the web page function. It can be used for browsing
or to change setting of printer setup.
6.5.5.6.1 Warning indication when SSL is made valid by self-sign certificate
When SSL is made valid by self-sign certificate, the following picture is obtained when web
page is accessed, and page will not be displayed.
Web display when SSL is made valid by self-sign certificate
Web page display when "Continue browsing this site (not recommended)" is clicked.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-82 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.5.6 Wireless Troubleshooting
(1) Cannot print through Wireless Network.
Confirmation Items
Confirmation Tasks
Action at NG
Print
out the network information.
Check Network Connection
setting is Wireless.
Set Wireless setting by
Manual Setup or Auto
Setup (WPS) to connect
to wireless access
point.
Network Connection
setting switches from
Wired to Wireless.
(1) Check Network Connection setting.
Check Network Connection is
Wireless not Wired.
*1 : Check once again whether the SSID, security setting, and an encrypting key of the wireless LAN
access point are same as the settings of this device. When any one of settings is different, the
device cannot be connected to the wireless LAN access point.
Check that a WEP key index of the wireless LAN access point is 1 when the security settings of the
wireless LAN access point are WEP. When a WEP key index of the wireless LAN access point is not 1,
it can not communicate with this device.
When a time-out error is displayed after automatic setting (WPS-PBC/PIN) execution, the
connection setting with the wireless LAN access point is not completed in time.
Start WPS of the wireless LAN access point as soon as you start WPS of this device. (It is no
problem that you start WPS of the wireless LAN access point first. )
When an overlap error is displayed after automatic setting (WPS-PBC) execution, there is a device
carrying out WPS in others. Carry out WPS again after a while.
(2) Check the connection to the wireless LAN access point.
Check that the wireless LAN
setting is right and the device
is connecting to the wireless
LAN access point.
Check the panel of the device,
and Check whether the status
(Not connected to wireless
access point.) has occurred.
*1
Check the panel of the device,
and Check whether the
status (Wireless settings are
incomplete.) has occurred.
The settings of SSID,
the security setting,
the encryption key, and
the certificate, etc. are
insufficient. Please set
all necessary settings.
(3) Check whether it is possible to communicate by way of wireless LAN.
Check whether it is possible
to communicate via wireless
LAN.
45487001TH Rev.1
Please refer to Network Troubleshooting for Checkation Tasks
and Action at NG.
Moreover, when wireless security is set to "WEP", the
connection to wireless LAN access point might not be able to
be communicated though does. Set it to the security setting of
wireless LAN access point additionally again.
6-83 /
6. Troubleshooting procedure
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
6.6 Paper cassette switches and paper size correlation table
(1) Source tray
Switch Part No. 2052000P4000
Model No: HS12-001
Bit Number
Switch Indication Size
TRAY1 TRAY4
No cassette
Legal13" Legal14"
A4
Letter
Executive
B5
COM10
A5
Press of SW: L
When Legal is selected, three options, Legal 13, Legal 13.5 and Legal 14
are selectable.
45487001TH Rev.1
6-84 /
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7. Connection diagrams
7.1 Resistance value check...............................................................7-2
7.2 Parts location...............................................................................7-5
7.3 F/W version number..................................................................7-12
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7.1Resistance value check
Unit
Electrical circuit diagram, connection
ID motor
Part outside view
Resistance value
Across both ends of IP2: 1 or less
IP2
Fuser unit motor
Across both ends of IP2: 1 or less
IP2
45487001TH Rev.1
7-2 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Unit
Electrical circuit diagram, connection
Feed motor
Part outside view
Resistance value
Across both ends of F1: 1 or less
F1
COLOR OF
LEAD
Duplex motor
PHR-6
PIN No.
PHR-6
PIN No.
COLOR OF
LEAD
RED
1
(A)
4
(B)
YELLOW
BLUE
3
(A)
6
(B)
WHITE
Between pin-1 and pin-3: 3.2
Between pin-4 and pin-6: 3.2
M
2nd / 3rd / 4th tray
Between pin-1 and pin-2: 2.8
Between pin-3 and pin-4: 2.8
feed motor
3
4
45487001TH Rev.1
7-3 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
Unit
Electrical circuit diagram,
connection
Thermostat
Part outside view
Resistance value
Upper (Halogen heater)
800W
1
3
Upper
Lower
(Halogen heater)
400W
2
4
09P-RWZV-K4GG-P4
CZHR-05V-S
Fuser unit
Upper
Thermistor
(PM9-342)
Compensation
Thermistor
(PT3-312)
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
Between pins -A5 and -A4: Approx. 80.58k to 5338k (0 to 93C)
Between pins -A3 and -A2: Approx. 104.5k to 806.5k (0 to 43C)
Between pins -B4 and -B3: Approx. 104.5k to 806.5k (0 to 43C)
Between pins -B2 and -B1: Open
09P-RWZV-K4GG-P4
CZHR-04V-S
Upper Side
Thermistor
(PTA7-312)
Fuse
2
4
B4
B3
B2
3 4pin(B4)
B1
09P-RWZV-K4GG-P4
45487001TH Rev.1
5pin(A5)
7-4 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7.2 Parts location
(1) Print Controll PCB (PU/CU PCB)
Componet side
C260
OSC10
2
1
7
LAN2
IC35
12
L13
L14
L11
L12
48
48
25
C283
Q17
Q18
45075699
Q16
F2A
32V
1
27
28
10
Q8
F1A
32V
R62
C277
R70
1
1
45487001TH Rev.1
HVOLT
15
IL
F2A
32V
DUPSNS
C19
F5
F1A
32V
F1
12
10
R73
R74
R71
R72
F2A
32V
R75
12
C42
R87
F2A
32V
4 4
32
143
USB3
C65
25
F2A
32V
C64
12
F4A
32V
USB1
1
4
2
3
RM24
IC13
9
C62
C49
144
1 2
1
A
R
1
4
1
5
22
21
C56
24
FLCS
RM13
C61
C57
1
38
RM14
F2A
32V
24
IC17
39
17
RM17
RM22
1
21
F1A
32V
1
7
8
12
C262
C263
C219
42
R170
R165
DIMM
F2.5A
32V
BF7
AP
IC24
451020
R90
1
A
R202
C266
C270
C269
R260
C271
C274
C272
C214
C226
10
Board-99M
D18 D19 D20
10
RM26
R247
R245
R241
R238
20
RM30
9
A
1
A
R
1
37
39
40
C141
R237
RM27
38
R246
R244
20
R253
C224
C233
RM28
C146
C147
IC25
RM31
C192
BF27
C305
C308
C310
C124
R486
34
C159
IC22
AP
R273
C225
AA
R271
R272
34
C311
C309
C306
BF26
LAN
R457
C267
C156
C172
C215
C286
C287
C276
C275
C278
C285
C279
C288
C273
R404
F13
F1A
32V
C211
C209
C210
16
R270
21
17
32
1
CP15
WLPOW
24
R89
BF13
BF14
IC28
C265
F17
F2A
32V
F1A
32V
25
28
R464
R487
HEAD0
STKL
1
R453
C115
R484
BAT1
TAGZA3
10
11
HEAT
RSNS
99M
C4
C3
7-5 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
R846
C683
C687
C714
R689
4
R848
7
R699
C750
R696
R698
C749
R857
15 1412 10 8
R705
R704
R697
R863
C704
192
R700
C748
IC508
193
R701
R862
256
1
R847
C675
R703
R702
C747
R780
R779
R778
C681
R690
R688
R686
R685
R680
R865
R768
R793
R792
R791
R790
R796
R867
R707
R806
R805
R868
R832
R808
Soldering side
BF527
BF528
C752
C751
C753
64
129
65
IC507
128
C623
C738
C739
C740
BF529
RM510
R580
C562
R579
R578
R555
5
RM503
6
10
11
R536
C528
R864
R554
R553
C545
C540
C539
1
20
16
15
45487001TH Rev.1
R501
R506
C505
C504
Q503
C506
R508
R503
45075699
IC501
R855
C503
R502
R504
R516
R515
R513
R505
L502
L501
Q504
Q505
R511
R510
C733
R858
C510
R517
C509
R522
R521
R520
R519
R518
R527
R526
R525
R524
C512
C514
C513
C511
C725
Q506
R523
Q509
D501
C554
C546
C556
C520
C519
RM526
R540
R539
C530
RM527
RM504
C533
R569
C557
C555
C551
RM505
IC503
IC504
C534
C724
C552
Q501
C502
C501
RM506
C559
C548
36
C543
IC505
R552
R551
R550
25
R860
C723
37
R861
C527
24
R589
RM507
C550
C549
48
C542
13
C560
C558
R568
RM511
32
RM509
C711
R571
17
12
R601
R592
R590
R820
33
C574
C570
RM501
16
C578
C575
C580
48
RM508
C564
R581
49
1
R600
C566
C610
C602
C593
C588
R632
C572
64
C573
C611
C594
7-6 /
7-7 /
D514
D511
MAIN1
1
JP19
12
MAIN2
JP2
C540
C541
13
JP23
IC502
JP24
7
SNS12
CP1
JP29
R835
49
48
JP26
JP12
CL2
JP32
JP15
50
IC
33
64
32
JP7
JP21
PSZ
JP30
GOH
44605899
R591
R590
R585
R584
JP28
JP16
SNS03
R601
ZA1
R600
JP4
C518
R801
R602
JP3
D513
D512
R501
C520
C519
JP20
R599
C537
R546
R832
C502
R838
R506
R527
R518
C535
C534
C533
C532
R583
R582
16
17
FET501
44605899
JP18
JP31
R589
R588
D516
JP10
R581
C531
C530
R802
45487001TH Rev.1
R594
JP9
R507
Board-GOH
JP11
3 3
R578
JP8
JP13
R575
C528
C527
C529
C524
TR502
R593
R577
JP17
JP5
Q504
R830
R576
C523
R544
R535
CP2
C513
D1
R545
R543
R825
R542
F501
12
R547
4
1
MOTOR
JP14
CL1
Componet side
Soldering side
(2) Second Tray Control PCB
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7. Connection diagrams
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(3) Control panel PCB (PCQ PCB)
(4) Environmental sensor PCB (enlargement)
Component side
Soldering side
CN4
CN503
CN501
SW7
R24
R20 R22
Q2 R21 R23 Q3
R528
R517
R512 C506
LED3
R522
HSNS
LED1
LED2
R19
IC3
R15
C507
R513
C18
R25
TH1
SW0
B2
RM534
FG2
C2
C4
R6
C5
Environmental
sensor PCB
R7
C6
C11
RM501
OSC1
24
IC501
SW1
Q1
12
48
RM502
SW2
SW3
RM505
R508
R507
R506
R505
R504
C504
C505
CN502
CP1
SW6
R502
R525
R524
C509
37
36
R511
R510
R509
R2
C8
12
25
R8
CN1
13
R15
R26
R27
RM504
C12
C7
C1
RM503
D1
R13
C502
SW5
SW4
C501
R501
R530
Q501
R503
SW8
SW11
SW14
SW17
Q503
R520
R519
FG1
SW10
SW13
SW16
SW19
R514
R533
R527
Q502
SW9
SW12
SW15
SW18
R516
R515
R12
R11
R14
45487001TH Rev.1
7-8 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
(5) Toner sensor PCB
(7) Hopping sensor PCB
Componet side
SNS
K
A
E
C
44634799
44413799 1
97T
3 1
R1
HSC
K
A
SNS
CN
3
E
C
CN
Soldering side
44634799
3
C501
(6) Front sensor PCB
1
CN
45487001TH Rev.1
LED501
R501
WR
P6A
R1
R2
44711699 2 2
CN1
IN
IN2
44711699 2
2
(8) Switch PCB
SW501
7-9 /
7-10 /
S
JP40
JP45
JP42
CN5
JP34
JP56
JP52
JP51
R665
1
JP54
C534
R569
JP57
JP58
Q5
R622
R621
Q6
D521
45487001TH Rev.1
JP3
JP22
JP37
JP41
JP55
JP35
JP27
99H
R623
C550
R637 R642 R655 R660 R664
JP14
CP2
T4
6
JP17
R671
1
T3
JP59
C557
2
1
C12
C6
JP4
JP12
JP16
14
15
D6
Q2
T5
C1
C13
2 2
JP23
CP3
45075399
D1
JP48
5
CAUTION
HIGH VOLTAGE
C11
C7
CN1
D12
JP29
JP30
JP31
JP44
JP43
JP36
JP5
JP9
C4
JP18
SOLDER
Green
6
CP4
SB
C2
5
JP21
JP6
S7
S8
JP19
Q3
T6
D5
D11
S5
S6
4
JP49
JP50
CP5
JP7
JP2
C9
D2
R1
R669
D7
R641
Q1
JP8
IC507
R648
Q516
S3
S4
450989
JP47
R638
R666
R600
DB
R580
R574
JP24
R676
D522
R647
R658
R657
C511
R579
C513
1
13
40
14
39
6
D10
JP28
RETURN
C8
JP13
S12
S11
C5
T1
Q4
JP39
CN4
2 2
26
27
JP26
JP53
JP20
C10
R675
R674
C569
JP15
3
D4
CN3
CN2
OUTPUT
45075399
52
D9
JP32
JP33
S9
S10
C568
R668
CH
Board-99H
C14
D8
T2
F501
D13
JP46
R629
R634
R667
R611
R617
D520
C547
R610
JP1
D519
R605
R613
R612
C545
C508
R516
C507
R570
C505
R663
R662
D524
C528
Componet side
Soldering side
(9) High-Voltage Poser Supply PCB
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7. Connection diagrams
45487001TH Rev.1
HS104
CN003
CN002
F001
250V T20A
F1C1
G101
TH601
VS001
PI601
C001
PI602
CC2100
TH602
F1C2
FB001
L001
PI603
SECONDARY
L006
C007
F002 250V T10AH
U84PA
FB006
L002
FOR CONTINUED PROTECTION
AGAINST RISK OF FIRE ,
REPLACE ONLY WITH SAME TYPE
AND RATING OF FUSE .
CAUTION
PRIMARY
L005
C006
HS102
C010
C009
E0013648
C005
R030
1 45
C008
Q103
L004
RL002
C101
Q401
C109
FB100
Q101
C510
C516
HS101
E
Q403
D101
ADHE
SIVE
FB101
RC101
AVERTISSEMENT
ADVERTENCIA
WARNING
FB005
FB502
HS103
Q304
PRIMARY
C150
IC551
C131
C152
SECONDARY
HEATSINK AND TRANSFORMER CORE PRESENT RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK . TEST BEFORE TOUCHING .
FB007
R515
ADHE
SIVE
C111
Q405
FB500
FB021
R435
SUB1
T001
Q202
C251
C252
Q203
SUB2
C307
L300
L201
C210
C209
FB501
G102
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7. Connection diagrams
(10) Low-Voltage Poser Supply PCB
Componet side
Soldering side
7-11 /
FB002
CN004
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
99G
45177599
1
2 2
12
CN1
(11) ID TAG PCB
CN3
CN3
45487001TH Rev.1
12
12
CN2
99G
45177599
1
2 2
CN1
(12) TC TAG PCB
7-12 /
7. Connection diagrams
Oki Data CONFIDENTIAL
7.3 F/W version number
7.3.1 Maintenance board indication stamp
Board 99M(YU)
Series No.
Use for
451020 [01]
99M-1 (45075601)
B721 ODA
451020 [02]
99M-1 (45075601)
B721 OEL/AOS
451020 [03]
99M-1 (45075601)
B731 ODA
451020 [04]
99M-1 (45075601)
B731 OEL/AOS
451020 [05]
99M-1 (45075601)
ES7131 OEL/AOS
451020 [06]
99M-1 (45075601)
MPS 5501b ODA/ODB
2
1
12
LAN2
8
12
LAN
IC35
In accordance with the following list, a specified part number is stamped on the maintenance
board indication field on PU/CU board.
Stamp No.
Series No. (Maintenance Board
Series No.)
L13
L12
L11
L14
Board-99M
Specified stamping location
451020
39
2
3
38
17
45487001TH Rev.1
USB1
42
1
1
4
BF7
22
21
7-13 /